]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
0f34d26c3de95b64ed0f5cb327ac297fdb81f0be
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988-1999
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c
5 @c %**start of header
6 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8 @setfilename gdb.info
9 @c
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c
12 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
13 @setchapternewpage odd
14 @c %**end of header
15
16 @iftex
17 @c @smallbook
18 @c @cropmarks
19 @end iftex
20
21 @finalout
22 @syncodeindex ky cp
23
24 @c readline appendices use @vindex
25 @syncodeindex vr cp
26
27 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
28 @set EDITION Seventh
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
31 @set DATE February 1999
32
33 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO-2 macros and info-makers to format properly.
34
35 @ifinfo
36 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
37 @c manuals to an info tree. zoo@cygnus.com is developing this facility.
38 @format
39 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
40 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
41 END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
42 @end format
43 @end ifinfo
44 @c
45 @c
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
51 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
52 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
57 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
58 are preserved on all copies.
59
60 @ignore
61 Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
62 results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
63 notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
64 (this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
65
66 @end ignore
67 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
68 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
69 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
70 permission notice identical to this one.
71
72 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
73 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
74 @end ifinfo
75
76 @titlepage
77 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81 @subtitle @value{DATE}
82 @author Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch
83 @page
84 @tex
85 {\parskip=0pt
86 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
87 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89 }
90 @end tex
91
92 @c ISBN seems to be wrong...
93
94 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
95 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96 @sp 2
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
99 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
100 Printed copies are available for $20 each. @*
101 ISBN 1-882114-11-6 @*
102
103 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
104 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
105 are preserved on all copies.
106
107 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
108 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
109 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
110 permission notice identical to this one.
111
112 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
113 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
114 @end titlepage
115 @page
116
117 @ifinfo
118 @node Top
119 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
120
121 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
122
123 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
124 @value{GDBVN}.
125
126 Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
127 @menu
128 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
129 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
130
131 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
132 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
133 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
134 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
135 * Stack:: Examining the stack
136 * Source:: Examining source files
137 * Data:: Examining data
138
139 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
140
141 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
142 * Altering:: Altering execution
143 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
144 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
145 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
148 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
149
150 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
151 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
152
153 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
154 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
155 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
156 * Index:: Index
157 @end menu
158
159 @end ifinfo
160
161 @node Summary
162 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
163
164 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
165 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
166 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
167
168 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
169 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
170
171 @itemize @bullet
172 @item
173 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
174
175 @item
176 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
177
178 @item
179 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
180
181 @item
182 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
183 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
184 @end itemize
185
186 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
187 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
188 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
189
190 @cindex Chill
191 @cindex Modula-2
192 Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
193 see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
194
195 @cindex Pascal
196 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
197 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
198 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
199 syntax.
200
201 @cindex Fortran
202 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
203 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
204 underscore.
205
206 @menu
207 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
208 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
209 @end menu
210
211 @node Free Software
212 @unnumberedsec Free software
213
214 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
215 General Public License
216 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
217 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
218 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
219 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
220 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
221 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
222
223 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
224 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
225 from anyone else.
226
227 @node Contributors
228 @unnumberedsec Contributors to GDB
229
230 Richard Stallman was the original author of GDB, and of many other
231 @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its development.
232 This section attempts to credit major contributors. One of the virtues
233 of free software is that everyone is free to contribute to it; with
234 regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The file
235 @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
236 blow-by-blow account.
237
238 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
239
240 @quotation
241 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
242 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
243 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
244 @end quotation
245
246 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
247 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
248 releases:
249 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
250 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
251 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
252 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
253 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
254 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
255 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
256 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
257
258 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
259 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
260
261 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in GDB,
262 with significant additional contributions from Per Bothner. James
263 Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on C++ was by Peter
264 TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading to release 3.0).
265
266 @value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
267 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
268 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
269
270 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
271 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
272
273 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
274
275 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
276 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
277 support.
278 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
279 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
280 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
281 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
282 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
283 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
284 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
285 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
286 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
287 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
288 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
289 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
290 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
291 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
292 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
293
294 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
295
296 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
297 libraries.
298
299 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
300 about several machine instruction sets.
301
302 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
303 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
304 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
305 and RDI targets, respectively.
306
307 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
308 command-line editing and command history.
309
310 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
311 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
312
313 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
314 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
315 symbols.
316
317 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
318 Super-H processors.
319
320 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
321
322 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
323
324 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
325
326 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
327
328 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors
329
330 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
331 watchpoints.
332
333 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
334
335 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
336
337 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
338 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout GDB.
339
340 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
341 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
342 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
343 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
344 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
345 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
346 information in this manual.
347
348 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored GDB maintenance and much of its
349 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on GDB
350 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
351 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
352 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
353 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
354 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
355 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
356 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
357 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
358 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
359 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
360 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
361 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
362 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
363
364
365 @node Sample Session
366 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
367
368 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
369 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
370 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
371
372 @iftex
373 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
374 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
375 @end iftex
376
377 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
378 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
379
380 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
381 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
382 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
383 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
384 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
385 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
386 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
387 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
388 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
389
390 @smallexample
391 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
392 $ @b{./m4}
393 @b{define(foo,0000)}
394
395 @b{foo}
396 0000
397 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
398
399 @b{bar}
400 0000
401 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
402
403 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
404 @b{baz}
405 @b{C-d}
406 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
407 @end smallexample
408
409 @noindent
410 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
411
412 @smallexample
413 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
414 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
415 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
416 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
417 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
418 the conditions.
419 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
420 for details.
421
422 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
423 (@value{GDBP})
424 @end smallexample
425
426 @noindent
427 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
428 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
429 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
430 that examples fit in this manual.
431
432 @smallexample
433 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
434 @end smallexample
435
436 @noindent
437 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
438 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
439 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
440 @code{break} command.
441
442 @smallexample
443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
444 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
445 @end smallexample
446
447 @noindent
448 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
449 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
450 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
451
452 @smallexample
453 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
454 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
455 @b{define(foo,0000)}
456
457 @b{foo}
458 0000
459 @end smallexample
460
461 @noindent
462 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
463 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
464 context where it stops.
465
466 @smallexample
467 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
468
469 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
470 at builtin.c:879
471 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
472 @end smallexample
473
474 @noindent
475 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
476 the next line of the current function.
477
478 @smallexample
479 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
480 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
481 : nil,
482 @end smallexample
483
484 @noindent
485 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
486 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
487 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
488 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
489
490 @smallexample
491 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
492 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
493 at input.c:530
494 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
495 @end smallexample
496
497 @noindent
498 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
499 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
500 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
501 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
502 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
503 stack frame for each active subroutine.
504
505 @smallexample
506 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
507 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
508 at input.c:530
509 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
510 at builtin.c:882
511 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
512 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
513 at macro.c:71
514 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
515 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
516 @end smallexample
517
518 @noindent
519 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
520 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
521 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
522
523 @smallexample
524 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
525 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
526 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
527 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
528 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
529 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
530 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
531 : xstrdup(rq);
532 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
534 @end smallexample
535
536 @noindent
537 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
538 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
539 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
540 (@code{print}) to see their values.
541
542 @smallexample
543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
544 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
545 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
546 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
547 @end smallexample
548
549 @noindent
550 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
551 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
552 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
553
554 @smallexample
555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
556 533 xfree(rquote);
557 534
558 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
559 : xstrdup (lq);
560 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
561 : xstrdup (rq);
562 537
563 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
564 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
565 540 @}
566 541
567 542 void
568 @end smallexample
569
570 @noindent
571 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
572 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
573
574 @smallexample
575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
576 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
577 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
578 540 @}
579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
580 $3 = 9
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
582 $4 = 7
583 @end smallexample
584
585 @noindent
586 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
587 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
588 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
589 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
590 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
591 assignments.
592
593 @smallexample
594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
595 $5 = 7
596 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
597 $6 = 9
598 @end smallexample
599
600 @noindent
601 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
602 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
603 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
604 example that caused trouble initially:
605
606 @smallexample
607 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
608 Continuing.
609
610 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
611
612 baz
613 0000
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
618 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
619 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
620
621 @smallexample
622 @b{C-d}
623 Program exited normally.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
628 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
629 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
633 @end smallexample
634
635 @node Invocation
636 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
637
638 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
639 The essentials are:
640 @itemize @bullet
641 @item
642 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
643 @item
644 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
645 @end itemize
646
647 @menu
648 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
649 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
650 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
651 @end menu
652
653 @node Invoking GDB
654 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
655
656 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
657 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
658
659 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
660 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
661
662 The command-line options described here are designed
663 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
664 options may effectively be unavailable.
665
666 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
667 specifying an executable program:
668
669 @example
670 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
671 @end example
672
673 @noindent
674 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
675 specified:
676
677 @example
678 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
679 @end example
680
681 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
682 to debug a running process:
683
684 @example
685 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
686 @end example
687
688 @noindent
689 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
690 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
691
692 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
693 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
694 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
695 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
696 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
697
698 You can run @code{gdb} without printing the front material, which describes
699 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
700
701 @smallexample
702 @value{GDBP} -silent
703 @end smallexample
704
705 @noindent
706 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
707 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
708
709 @noindent
710 Type
711
712 @example
713 @value{GDBP} -help
714 @end example
715
716 @noindent
717 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
718 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
719
720 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
721 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
722 @samp{-x} option is used.
723
724
725 @menu
726 * File Options:: Choosing files
727 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
728 @end menu
729
730 @node File Options
731 @subsection Choosing files
732
733 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
734 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
735 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
736 @samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
737 that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
738 @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
739 that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
740 the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
741
742 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
743 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
744 argument and ignore it.
745
746 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
747 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
748 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
749 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
750 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
751
752 @table @code
753 @item -symbols @var{file}
754 @itemx -s @var{file}
755 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
756
757 @item -exec @var{file}
758 @itemx -e @var{file}
759 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
760 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
761
762 @item -se @var{file}
763 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
764 file.
765
766 @item -core @var{file}
767 @itemx -c @var{file}
768 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
769
770 @item -c @var{number}
771 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
772 (unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
773 case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
774
775 @item -command @var{file}
776 @itemx -x @var{file}
777 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
778 Files,, Command files}.
779
780 @item -directory @var{directory}
781 @itemx -d @var{directory}
782 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
783
784 @item -m
785 @itemx -mapped
786 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
787 supported on all systems.}@*
788 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
789 system call, you can use this option
790 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
791 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
792 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{./fred.syms}.
793 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
794 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
795 the symbol table from the executable program.
796
797 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
798 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
799 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
800
801 @item -r
802 @itemx -readnow
803 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
804 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
805 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
806
807 @end table
808
809 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
810 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
811 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
812 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
813 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
814
815 @example
816 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
817 @end example
818
819 @node Mode Options
820 @subsection Choosing modes
821
822 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
823 batch mode or quiet mode.
824
825 @table @code
826 @item -nx
827 @itemx -n
828 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
829 called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
830 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
831 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
832 files}.
833
834 @item -quiet
835 @itemx -q
836 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
837 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
838
839 @item -batch
840 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
841 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
842 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
843 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
844 in the command files.
845
846 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
847 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
848 make this more useful, the message
849
850 @example
851 Program exited normally.
852 @end example
853
854 @noindent
855 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
856 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
857 mode.
858
859 @item -nowindows
860 @itemx -nw
861 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
862 (GUI) built in, then this option tells GDB to only use the command-line
863 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
864
865 @item -windows
866 @itemx -w
867 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
868 used if possible.
869
870 @item -cd @var{directory}
871 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
872 instead of the current directory.
873
874 @item -fullname
875 @itemx -f
876 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
877 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
878 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
879 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
880 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
881 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
882 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
883 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
884 frame.
885
886 @item -baud @var{bps}
887 @itemx -b @var{bps}
888 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
889 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
890
891 @item -tty @var{device}
892 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
893 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
894
895 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
896 @c @item -tui
897 @c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
898 @c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
899 @c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
900 @c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
901 @c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
902
903 @c @item -xdb
904 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
905 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
906 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
907 @c systems.
908
909 @end table
910
911 @node Quitting GDB
912 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
913 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
914 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
915
916 @table @code
917 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
918 @kindex q
919 @item quit
920 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated @code{q}), or
921 type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you do not supply
922 @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; otherwise it will
923 terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the error code.
924 @end table
925
926 @cindex interrupt
927 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
928 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
929 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
930 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
931 until a time when it is safe.
932
933 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
934 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
935 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
936
937 @node Shell Commands
938 @section Shell commands
939
940 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
941 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
942 just use the @code{shell} command.
943
944 @table @code
945 @kindex shell
946 @cindex shell escape
947 @item shell @var{command string}
948 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
949 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
950 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
951 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
952 @end table
953
954 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
955 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
956 @value{GDBN}:
957
958 @table @code
959 @kindex make
960 @cindex calling make
961 @item make @var{make-args}
962 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
963 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
964 @end table
965
966 @node Commands
967 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
968
969 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
970 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
971 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
972 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
973 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
974
975 @menu
976 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
977 * Completion:: Command completion
978 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
979 @end menu
980
981 @node Command Syntax
982 @section Command syntax
983
984 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
985 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
986 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
987 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
988 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
989 with no arguments. Some command names do not allow any arguments.
990
991 @cindex abbreviation
992 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
993 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
994 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
995 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
996 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
997 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
998 arguments to the @code{help} command.
999
1000 @cindex repeating commands
1001 @kindex RET
1002 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1003 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1004 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1005 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1006 repeat.
1007
1008 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1009 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1010 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1011
1012 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1013 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1014 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1015 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1016 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1017
1018 @kindex #
1019 @cindex comment
1020 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1021 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1022 Files,,Command files}).
1023
1024 @node Completion
1025 @section Command completion
1026
1027 @cindex completion
1028 @cindex word completion
1029 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1030 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1031 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1032 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1033
1034 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1035 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1036 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1037 enter it). For example, if you type
1038
1039 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1040 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1041 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1042 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1043 @example
1044 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1045 @end example
1046
1047 @noindent
1048 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1049 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1050
1051 @example
1052 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1053 @end example
1054
1055 @noindent
1056 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1057 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1058 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1059 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1060 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1061 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1062
1063 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1064 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1065 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1066 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1067 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1068 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1069 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1070 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1071 example:
1072
1073 @example
1074 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1075 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1076 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1077 make_abs_section make_function_type
1078 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1079 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1080 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1081 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1082 @end example
1083
1084 @noindent
1085 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1086 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1087 command.
1088
1089 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1090 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1091 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1092 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1093 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1094
1095 @cindex quotes in commands
1096 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1097 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1098 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1099 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1100 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1101 @value{GDBN} commands.
1102
1103 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1104 name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1105 (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1106 type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1107 distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1108 @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1109 @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1110 facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1111 beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1112 consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1113 @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1114
1115 @example
1116 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @key{M-?}
1117 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1118 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1119 @end example
1120
1121 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1122 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1123 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1124 place:
1125
1126 @example
1127 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1128 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1129 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1130 @end example
1131
1132 @noindent
1133 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1134 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1135 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1136
1137 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1138 expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1139 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1140 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
1141
1142
1143 @node Help
1144 @section Getting help
1145 @cindex online documentation
1146 @kindex help
1147
1148 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1149 using the command @code{help}.
1150
1151 @table @code
1152 @kindex h
1153 @item help
1154 @itemx h
1155 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1156 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1157
1158 @smallexample
1159 (@value{GDBP}) help
1160 List of classes of commands:
1161
1162 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1163 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1164 data -- Examining data
1165 files -- Specifying and examining files
1166 internals -- Maintenance commands
1167 obscure -- Obscure features
1168 running -- Running the program
1169 stack -- Examining the stack
1170 status -- Status inquiries
1171 support -- Support facilities
1172 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without stopping the program
1173 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1174
1175 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1176 commands in that class.
1177 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1178 documentation.
1179 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1180 (@value{GDBP})
1181 @end smallexample
1182
1183 @item help @var{class}
1184 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1185 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1186 help display for the class @code{status}:
1187
1188 @smallexample
1189 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1190 Status inquiries.
1191
1192 List of commands:
1193
1194 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1195 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1196 info -- Generic command for showing things
1197 about the program being debugged
1198 show -- Generic command for showing things
1199 about the debugger
1200
1201 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1202 documentation.
1203 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1204 (@value{GDBP})
1205 @end smallexample
1206
1207 @item help @var{command}
1208 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1209 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1210
1211 @kindex complete
1212 @item complete @var{args}
1213 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1214 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1215 command you want completed. For example:
1216
1217 @smallexample
1218 complete i
1219 @end smallexample
1220
1221 @noindent results in:
1222
1223 @smallexample
1224 @group
1225 if
1226 ignore
1227 info
1228 inspect
1229 @end group
1230 @end smallexample
1231
1232 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1233 @end table
1234
1235 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1236 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1237 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1238 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1239 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1240 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1241
1242 @c @group
1243 @table @code
1244 @kindex info
1245 @kindex i
1246 @item info
1247 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1248 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1249 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1250 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1251 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1252 @w{@code{help info}}.
1253
1254 @kindex set
1255 @item set
1256 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1257 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1258 @code{set prompt $}.
1259
1260 @kindex show
1261 @item show
1262 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1263 @value{GDBN} itself.
1264 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1265 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1266 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1267 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1268
1269 @kindex info set
1270 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1271 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1272 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1273 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1274 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1275 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1276 @end table
1277 @c @end group
1278
1279 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1280 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1281
1282 @table @code
1283 @kindex show version
1284 @cindex version number
1285 @item show version
1286 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1287 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1288 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1289 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1290 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1291 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1292 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in GNU/Linux distributions as well.
1293 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1294 @value{GDBN}.
1295
1296 @kindex show copying
1297 @item show copying
1298 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1299
1300 @kindex show warranty
1301 @item show warranty
1302 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1303 if your version of @value{GDB} comes with one.
1304
1305 @end table
1306
1307 @node Running
1308 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1309
1310 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1311 debugging information when you compile it.
1312
1313 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1314 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1315 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1316 kill a child process.
1317
1318 @menu
1319 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1320 * Starting:: Starting your program
1321 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1322 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1323
1324 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1325 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1326 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1327 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1328
1329 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1330 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1331 @end menu
1332
1333 @node Compilation
1334 @section Compiling for debugging
1335
1336 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1337 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1338 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1339 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1340 and addresses in the executable code.
1341
1342 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1343 the compiler.
1344
1345 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1346 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1347 executables containing debugging information.
1348
1349 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1350 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1351 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1352 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1353 in pushing your luck.
1354
1355 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1356 @cindex debugging optimized code
1357 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1358 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1359 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1360 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1361 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1362 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1363
1364 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1365 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1366 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1367 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1368
1369 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1370 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1371 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1372
1373 @need 2000
1374 @node Starting
1375 @section Starting your program
1376 @cindex starting
1377 @cindex running
1378
1379 @table @code
1380 @kindex run
1381 @item run
1382 @itemx r
1383 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1384 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1385 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1386 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1387 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1388
1389 @end table
1390
1391 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1392 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1393 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1394 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1395
1396 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1397 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1398 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1399 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1400 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1401 divided into four categories:
1402
1403 @table @asis
1404 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1405 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1406 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1407 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1408 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1409 the arguments.
1410 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1411 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1412 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1413
1414 @item The @emph{environment.}
1415 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1416 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1417 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1418 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1419
1420 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1421 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1422 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1423 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1424
1425 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1426 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1427 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1428 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1429 set a different device for your program.
1430 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1431
1432 @cindex pipes
1433 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1434 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1435 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1436 wrong program.
1437 @end table
1438
1439 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1440 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1441 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1442 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1443 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1444
1445 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1446 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1447 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1448 your current breakpoints.
1449
1450 @node Arguments
1451 @section Your program's arguments
1452
1453 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1454 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1455 @code{run} command.
1456 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1457 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1458 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1459 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1460 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1461
1462 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1463 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1464 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1465 the program, not by the shell.
1466
1467 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1468 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1469
1470 @kindex set args
1471 @table @code
1472 @item set args
1473 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1474 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1475 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1476 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1477 it again without arguments.
1478
1479 @kindex show args
1480 @item show args
1481 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1482 @end table
1483
1484 @node Environment
1485 @section Your program's environment
1486
1487 @cindex environment (of your program)
1488 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1489 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1490 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1491 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1492 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1493 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1494 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1495
1496 @table @code
1497 @kindex path
1498 @item path @var{directory}
1499 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1500 (the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
1501 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1502 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1503 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1504 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1505
1506 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1507 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1508 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1509 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1510 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1511 @var{directory} to the search path.
1512 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1513 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1514
1515 @kindex show paths
1516 @item show paths
1517 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1518 environment variable).
1519
1520 @kindex show environment
1521 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1522 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1523 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1524 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1525 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1526
1527 @kindex set environment
1528 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1529 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1530 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1531 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1532 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1533 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1534 null value.
1535 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1536 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1537
1538 For example, this command:
1539
1540 @example
1541 set env USER = foo
1542 @end example
1543
1544 @noindent
1545 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1546 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1547 are not actually required.)
1548
1549 @kindex unset environment
1550 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1551 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1552 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1553 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1554 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1555 @end table
1556
1557 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1558 the shell indicated
1559 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1560 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1561 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1562 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1563 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1564 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1565 @file{.profile}.
1566
1567 @node Working Directory
1568 @section Your program's working directory
1569
1570 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1571 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1572 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1573 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1574 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1575 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1576
1577 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1578 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1579 specify files}.
1580
1581 @table @code
1582 @kindex cd
1583 @item cd @var{directory}
1584 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1585
1586 @kindex pwd
1587 @item pwd
1588 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1589 @end table
1590
1591 @node Input/Output
1592 @section Your program's input and output
1593
1594 @cindex redirection
1595 @cindex i/o
1596 @cindex terminal
1597 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1598 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1599 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1600 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1601 running your program.
1602
1603 @table @code
1604 @kindex info terminal
1605 @item info terminal
1606 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1607 program is using.
1608 @end table
1609
1610 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1611 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1612
1613 @example
1614 run > outfile
1615 @end example
1616
1617 @noindent
1618 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1619
1620 @kindex tty
1621 @cindex controlling terminal
1622 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1623 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1624 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1625 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1626 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1627
1628 @example
1629 tty /dev/ttyb
1630 @end example
1631
1632 @noindent
1633 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1634 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1635 that as their controlling terminal.
1636
1637 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1638 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1639 terminal.
1640
1641 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1642 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1643 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1644
1645 @node Attach
1646 @section Debugging an already-running process
1647 @kindex attach
1648 @cindex attach
1649
1650 @table @code
1651 @item attach @var{process-id}
1652 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1653 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1654 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1655 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1656 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1657
1658 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1659 executing the command.
1660 @end table
1661
1662 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1663 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1664 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1665 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1666
1667 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1668 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1669 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1670 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1671 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1672 Specify Files}.
1673
1674 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1675 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1676 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1677 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1678 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1679 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1680 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1681
1682 @table @code
1683 @kindex detach
1684 @item detach
1685 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1686 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1687 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1688 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1689 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1690 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1691 executing the command.
1692 @end table
1693
1694 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1695 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1696 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1697 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1698 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1699 messages}).
1700
1701 @node Kill Process
1702 @section Killing the child process
1703
1704 @table @code
1705 @kindex kill
1706 @item kill
1707 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1708 @end table
1709
1710 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1711 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1712 is running.
1713
1714 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1715 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1716 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1717 outside the debugger.
1718
1719 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1720 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1721 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1722 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1723 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1724 breakpoint settings).
1725
1726 @node Threads
1727 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1728
1729 @cindex threads of execution
1730 @cindex multiple threads
1731 @cindex switching threads
1732 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1733 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1734 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1735 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1736 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1737 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1738 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1739
1740 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1741 programs:
1742
1743 @itemize @bullet
1744 @item automatic notification of new threads
1745 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1746 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1747 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1748 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1749 @item thread-specific breakpoints
1750 @end itemize
1751
1752 @quotation
1753 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1754 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1755 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1756 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1757 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1758 like this:
1759
1760 @smallexample
1761 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1762 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1763 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1764 see the IDs of currently known threads.
1765 @end smallexample
1766 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1767 @c doesn't support threads"?
1768 @end quotation
1769
1770 @cindex focus of debugging
1771 @cindex current thread
1772 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1773 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1774 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1775 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1776 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1777
1778 @kindex New @var{systag}
1779 @cindex thread identifier (system)
1780 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1781 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1782 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1783 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1784 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1785 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1786 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1787 LynxOS, you might see
1788
1789 @example
1790 [New process 35 thread 27]
1791 @end example
1792
1793 @noindent
1794 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1795 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1796 further qualifier.
1797
1798 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1799 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1800 @c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1801 @c program?
1802 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1803 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1804 @c threads ab initio?
1805
1806 @cindex thread number
1807 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1808 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1809 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1810
1811 @table @code
1812 @kindex info threads
1813 @item info threads
1814 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1815 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1816
1817 @enumerate
1818 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1819
1820 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1821
1822 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1823 @end enumerate
1824
1825 @noindent
1826 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1827 indicates the current thread.
1828
1829 For example,
1830 @end table
1831 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
1832
1833 @smallexample
1834 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1835 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1836 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1837 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
1838 at threadtest.c:68
1839 @end smallexample
1840
1841 On HP-UX systems:
1842
1843 @cindex thread number
1844 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1845 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1846 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
1847 thread in your program.
1848
1849 @kindex New @var{systag}
1850 @cindex thread identifier (system)
1851 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1852 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1853 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1854 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1855 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1856 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1857 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1858 HP-UX, you see
1859
1860 @example
1861 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
1862 @end example
1863
1864 @noindent
1865 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
1866
1867 @table @code
1868 @kindex info threads
1869 @item info threads
1870 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1871 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1872
1873 @enumerate
1874 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1875
1876 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1877
1878 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1879 @end enumerate
1880
1881 @noindent
1882 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1883 indicates the current thread.
1884
1885 For example,
1886 @end table
1887 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
1888
1889 @example
1890 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1891 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") at quicksort.c:137
1892 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1893 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1894 @end example
1895
1896 @table @code
1897 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
1898 @item thread @var{threadno}
1899 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
1900 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
1901 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
1902 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
1903 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
1904
1905 @smallexample
1906 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
1907 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
1908 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
1909 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1910 @end smallexample
1911
1912 @noindent
1913 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
1914 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
1915 threads.
1916
1917 @kindex thread apply
1918 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
1919 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
1920 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
1921 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
1922 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
1923 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
1924 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
1925 @end table
1926
1927 @cindex automatic thread selection
1928 @cindex switching threads automatically
1929 @cindex threads, automatic switching
1930 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
1931 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
1932 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
1933 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
1934 thread.
1935
1936 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
1937 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
1938 programs with multiple threads.
1939
1940 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
1941 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
1942
1943 @node Processes
1944 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
1945
1946 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
1947 @cindex multiple processes
1948 @cindex processes, multiple
1949 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
1950 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
1951 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
1952 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
1953 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
1954 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
1955 will cause it to terminate.
1956
1957 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
1958 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
1959 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
1960 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
1961 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
1962 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
1963 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
1964 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
1965 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
1966 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
1967
1968 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
1969 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
1970 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
1971
1972 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
1973 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
1974
1975 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
1976 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
1977
1978 @table @code
1979 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
1980 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
1981 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
1982 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
1983 process. The @var{mode} can be:
1984
1985 @table @code
1986 @item parent
1987 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
1988 unimpeded. This is the default.
1989
1990 @item child
1991 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
1992 unimpeded.
1993
1994 @item ask
1995 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
1996 @end table
1997
1998 @item show follow-fork-mode
1999 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2000 @end table
2001
2002 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2003 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2004 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2005 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2006 the child process's @code{main}.
2007
2008 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2009 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2010
2011 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2012 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2013 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2014 argument.
2015
2016 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2017 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2018 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2019
2020 @node Stopping
2021 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2022
2023 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2024 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2025 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2026
2027 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2028 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2029 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2030 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2031 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2032 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2033 explicitly request this information at any time.
2034
2035 @table @code
2036 @kindex info program
2037 @item info program
2038 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2039 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2040 @end table
2041
2042 @menu
2043 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2044 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2045 * Signals:: Signals
2046 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2047 @end menu
2048
2049 @node Breakpoints
2050 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2051
2052 @cindex breakpoints
2053 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2054 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2055 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2056 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2057 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2058 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2059 program.
2060
2061 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2062 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2063 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2064 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2065 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2066 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2067
2068 @cindex watchpoints
2069 @cindex memory tracing
2070 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2071 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2072 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2073 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2074 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2075 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2076 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2077 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2078
2079 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2080 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2081 Automatic display}.
2082
2083 @cindex catchpoints
2084 @cindex breakpoint on events
2085 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2086 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2087 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2088 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2089 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2090 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2091 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2092
2093 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2094 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2095 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2096 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2097 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2098 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2099 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2100 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2101 enable it again.
2102
2103 @menu
2104 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2105 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2106 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2107 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2108 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2109 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2110 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2111 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2112 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2113 @end menu
2114
2115 @node Set Breaks
2116 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2117
2118 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2119 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2120 @c
2121 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2122
2123 @kindex break
2124 @kindex b
2125 @kindex $bpnum
2126 @cindex latest breakpoint
2127 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2128 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2129 number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2130 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2131 convenience variables.
2132
2133 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2134
2135 @table @code
2136 @item break @var{function}
2137 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2138 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2139 C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2140 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2141
2142 @item break +@var{offset}
2143 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2144 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2145 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2146 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2147
2148 @item break @var{linenum}
2149 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2150 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2151 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2152 code on that line.
2153
2154 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2155 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2156
2157 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2158 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2159 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2160 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2161 functions.
2162
2163 @item break *@var{address}
2164 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2165 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2166 information or source files.
2167
2168 @item break
2169 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2170 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2171 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2172 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2173 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2174 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2175 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2176 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2177 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2178 inside loops.
2179
2180 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2181 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2182 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2183 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2184 existed when your program stopped.
2185
2186 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2187 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2188 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2189 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2190 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2191 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2192 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2193
2194 @kindex tbreak
2195 @item tbreak @var{args}
2196 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2197 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2198 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2199 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2200
2201 @kindex hbreak
2202 @item hbreak @var{args}
2203 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2204 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2205 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2206 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2207 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2208 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2209 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2210 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2211 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2212 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2213 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2214 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2215 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2216 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2217
2218 @kindex thbreak
2219 @item thbreak @var{args}
2220 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2221 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2222 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2223 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2224 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2225 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2226 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2227 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2228
2229 @kindex rbreak
2230 @cindex regular expression
2231 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2232 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2233 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2234 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2235 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2236 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2237 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2238
2239 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2240 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2241 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2242 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2243 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2244 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2245
2246 When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2247 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2248 classes.
2249
2250 @kindex info breakpoints
2251 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2252 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2253 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2254 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2255 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2256 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2257
2258 @table @emph
2259 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2260 @item Type
2261 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2262 @item Disposition
2263 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2264 @item Enabled or Disabled
2265 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2266 that are not enabled.
2267 @item Address
2268 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2269 @item What
2270 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2271 line number.
2272 @end table
2273
2274 @noindent
2275 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2276 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2277 are listed after that.
2278
2279 @noindent
2280 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2281 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2282 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2283 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2284 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2285
2286 @noindent
2287 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2288 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2289 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2290 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2291 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2292 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2293 @end table
2294
2295 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2296 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2297 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2298 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2299
2300 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2301 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2302 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2303 purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2304 These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2305 @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2306
2307 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2308 @samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2309
2310 @table @code
2311 @kindex maint info breakpoints
2312 @item maint info breakpoints
2313 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2314 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2315 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2316 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2317 is shown:
2318
2319 @table @code
2320 @item breakpoint
2321 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2322
2323 @item watchpoint
2324 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2325
2326 @item longjmp
2327 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2328 @code{longjmp} calls.
2329
2330 @item longjmp resume
2331 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2332
2333 @item until
2334 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2335
2336 @item finish
2337 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2338
2339 @item shlib events
2340 Shared library events.
2341
2342 @end table
2343
2344 @end table
2345
2346
2347 @node Set Watchpoints
2348 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2349
2350 @cindex setting watchpoints
2351 @cindex software watchpoints
2352 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2353 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2354 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2355 this may happen.
2356
2357 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2358 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2359 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2360 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2361 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2362 culprit.)
2363
2364 On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2365 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2366 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2367 program.
2368
2369 @table @code
2370 @kindex watch
2371 @item watch @var{expr}
2372 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2373 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2374
2375 @kindex rwatch
2376 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2377 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2378
2379 @kindex awatch
2380 @item awatch @var{expr}
2381 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2382 by the program.
2383
2384 @kindex info watchpoints
2385 @item info watchpoints
2386 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2387 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2388 @end table
2389
2390 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2391 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2392 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2393 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2394 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2395 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2396
2397 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2398
2399 @example
2400 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2401 @end example
2402
2403 @noindent
2404 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2405
2406 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2407 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2408 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2409 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2410 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2411 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2412 will print a message like this:
2413
2414 @smallexample
2415 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2416 @end smallexample
2417
2418 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2419 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2420 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2421 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2422 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2423 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2424 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2425 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2426
2427 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2428 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2429 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2430 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2431 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2432 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2433
2434 @smallexample
2435 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2436 @end smallexample
2437
2438 @noindent
2439 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2440
2441 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2442 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2443 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2444 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2445 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2446 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2447 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2448 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2449 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2450 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2451
2452 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2453 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2454 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2455
2456 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2457 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2458 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2459 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2460 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2461 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2462 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2463 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2464 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2465
2466 @quotation
2467 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2468 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2469 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2470 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2471 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2472 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2473 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2474 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2475 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2476 the expression.
2477
2478 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2479 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2480 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2481 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2482 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2483 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2484 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2485 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2486 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2487 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2488 @end quotation
2489
2490 @node Set Catchpoints
2491 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2492 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2493 @cindex exception handlers
2494 @cindex event handling
2495
2496 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2497 kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2498 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2499
2500 @table @code
2501 @kindex catch
2502 @item catch @var{event}
2503 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2504 @table @code
2505 @item throw
2506 @kindex catch throw
2507 The throwing of a C++ exception.
2508
2509 @item catch
2510 @kindex catch catch
2511 The catching of a C++ exception.
2512
2513 @item exec
2514 @kindex catch exec
2515 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2516
2517 @item fork
2518 @kindex catch fork
2519 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2520
2521 @item vfork
2522 @kindex catch vfork
2523 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2524
2525 @item load
2526 @itemx load @var{libname}
2527 @kindex catch load
2528 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2529 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2530
2531 @item unload
2532 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2533 @kindex catch unload
2534 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2535 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2536 @end table
2537
2538 @item tcatch @var{event}
2539 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2540 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2541
2542 @end table
2543
2544 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2545
2546 There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2547 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2548
2549 @itemize @bullet
2550 @item
2551 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2552 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2553 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2554 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2555 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2556 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2557 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2558 disabled within interactive calls.
2559
2560 @item
2561 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2562
2563 @item
2564 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2565 @end itemize
2566
2567 @cindex raise exceptions
2568 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2569 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2570 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2571 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2572 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2573 out where the exception was raised.
2574
2575 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2576 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2577 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2578 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2579
2580 @example
2581 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2582 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2583 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2584 @end example
2585
2586 @noindent
2587 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2588 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2589 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2590
2591 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2592 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2593 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2594 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2595 raised.
2596
2597
2598 @node Delete Breaks
2599 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2600
2601 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2602 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2603 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2604 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2605 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2606 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2607
2608 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2609 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2610 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2611 their breakpoint numbers.
2612
2613 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2614 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2615 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex clear
2619 @item clear
2620 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2621 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2622 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2623 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2624
2625 @item clear @var{function}
2626 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2627 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2628
2629 @item clear @var{linenum}
2630 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2631 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2632
2633 @cindex delete breakpoints
2634 @kindex delete
2635 @kindex d
2636 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2637 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the numbers
2638 specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2639 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2640 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2641 @end table
2642
2643 @node Disabling
2644 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2645
2646 @kindex disable breakpoints
2647 @kindex enable breakpoints
2648 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2649 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2650 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2651 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2652
2653 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2654 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2655 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2656 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2657 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2658
2659 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2660 states of enablement:
2661
2662 @itemize @bullet
2663 @item
2664 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2665 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2666 @item
2667 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2668 @item
2669 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2670 disabled.
2671 @item
2672 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2673 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2674 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2675 @end itemize
2676
2677 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2678 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2679
2680 @table @code
2681 @kindex disable breakpoints
2682 @kindex disable
2683 @kindex dis
2684 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2685 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2686 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2687 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2688 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2689 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2690
2691 @kindex enable breakpoints
2692 @kindex enable
2693 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{bnums}@dots{}@r{]}
2694 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2695 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2696
2697 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{bnums}@dots{}
2698 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2699 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2700
2701 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{bnums}@dots{}
2702 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2703 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2704 @end table
2705
2706 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2707 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2708 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2709 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2710 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2711 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2712 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2713 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2714 stepping}.)
2715
2716 @node Conditions
2717 @subsection Break conditions
2718 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2719 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2720
2721 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2722 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2723 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2724 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2725 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2726 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2727 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2728 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2729
2730 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2731 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2732 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2733 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2734 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2735
2736 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2737 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2738 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2739 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2740 one.
2741
2742 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2743 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2744 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2745 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2746 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2747 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2748 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
2749 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2750 conditions for the
2751 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2752 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2753
2754 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2755 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2756 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2757 with the @code{condition} command.
2758
2759 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2760 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2761 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2762 catchpoint.
2763
2764 @table @code
2765 @kindex condition
2766 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2767 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2768 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2769 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2770 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2771 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2772 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
2773 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2774 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2775 prints an error message:
2776
2777 @example
2778 No symbol "foo" in current context.
2779 @end example
2780
2781 @noindent
2782 @value{GDBN} does
2783 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
2784 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2785 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
2786
2787 @item condition @var{bnum}
2788 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2789 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2790 @end table
2791
2792 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2793 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2794 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2795 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2796 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2797 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2798 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2799 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2800 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2801 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2802 your program reaches it.
2803
2804 @table @code
2805 @kindex ignore
2806 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
2807 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
2808 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
2809 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
2810 takes no action.
2811
2812 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
2813 a count of zero.
2814
2815 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
2816 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
2817 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
2818 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
2819
2820 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
2821 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
2822 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
2823
2824 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
2825 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
2826 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
2827 variables}.
2828 @end table
2829
2830 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
2831
2832
2833 @node Break Commands
2834 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
2835
2836 @cindex breakpoint commands
2837 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
2838 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
2839 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
2840 enable other breakpoints.
2841
2842 @table @code
2843 @kindex commands
2844 @kindex end
2845 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
2846 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
2847 @itemx end
2848 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
2849 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
2850 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
2851
2852 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
2853 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
2854
2855 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
2856 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
2857 recently encountered).
2858 @end table
2859
2860 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
2861 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
2862
2863 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
2864 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
2865 that resumes execution.
2866
2867 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
2868 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
2869 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
2870 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
2871 ambiguities about which list to execute.
2872
2873 @kindex silent
2874 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
2875 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
2876 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
2877 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
2878 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
2879 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
2880
2881 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
2882 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
2883 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
2884
2885 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
2886 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
2887
2888 @example
2889 break foo if x>0
2890 commands
2891 silent
2892 printf "x is %d\n",x
2893 cont
2894 end
2895 @end example
2896
2897 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
2898 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
2899 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
2900 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
2901 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
2902 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
2903 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
2904
2905 @example
2906 break 403
2907 commands
2908 silent
2909 set x = y + 4
2910 cont
2911 end
2912 @end example
2913
2914 @node Breakpoint Menus
2915 @subsection Breakpoint menus
2916 @cindex overloading
2917 @cindex symbol overloading
2918
2919 Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
2920 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
2921 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
2922 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
2923 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
2924 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
2925 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
2926 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
2927 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
2928 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
2929 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
2930 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
2931 breakpoints.
2932
2933 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
2934 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
2935 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
2936
2937 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
2938 @smallexample
2939 @group
2940 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
2941 [0] cancel
2942 [1] all
2943 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
2944 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
2945 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
2946 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
2947 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
2948 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
2949 > 2 4 6
2950 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
2951 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
2952 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
2953 Multiple breakpoints were set.
2954 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
2955 breakpoints.
2956 (@value{GDBP})
2957 @end group
2958 @end smallexample
2959
2960 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
2961 @node Error in Breakpoints
2962 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2963 @c
2964 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
2965 @c
2966 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
2967 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
2968 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
2969 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
2970
2971 @example
2972 Cannot insert breakpoints.
2973 The same program may be running in another process.
2974 @end example
2975
2976 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
2977
2978 @enumerate
2979 @item
2980 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
2981
2982 @item
2983 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
2984 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
2985 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
2986 Then start your program again.
2987
2988 @item
2989 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
2990 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
2991 to nonsharable executables.
2992 @end enumerate
2993 @c @end ifclear
2994
2995 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
2996 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
2997
2998 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
2999 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3000 @smallexample
3001 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3002 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3003 @end smallexample
3004
3005 @noindent
3006 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3007 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3008 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3009
3010 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3011 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3012
3013
3014 @node Continuing and Stepping
3015 @section Continuing and stepping
3016
3017 @cindex stepping
3018 @cindex continuing
3019 @cindex resuming execution
3020 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3021 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3022 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3023 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3024 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3025 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3026 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3027 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3028
3029 @table @code
3030 @kindex continue
3031 @kindex c
3032 @kindex fg
3033 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3034 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3035 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3036 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3037 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3038 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3039 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3040 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3041
3042 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3043 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3044 @code{continue} is ignored.
3045
3046 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3047 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3048 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3049 @code{continue}.
3050 @end table
3051
3052 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3053 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3054 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3055 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3056
3057 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3058 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3059 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3060 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3061 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3062 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3063
3064 @table @code
3065 @kindex step
3066 @kindex s
3067 @item step
3068 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3069 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3070 abbreviated @code{s}.
3071
3072 @quotation
3073 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3074 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3075 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3076 @c distinction here.
3077 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3078 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3079 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3080 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3081 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3082 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3083 below.
3084 @end quotation
3085
3086 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3087 source line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3088 switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3089 function that has debugging information is called within the line.
3090 In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3091 within the line.
3092
3093 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3094 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3095 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3096 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3097 was any debugging information about the routine.
3098
3099 @item step @var{count}
3100 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3101 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3102 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3103
3104 @kindex next
3105 @kindex n
3106 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3107 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3108 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3109 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3110 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3111 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3112 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3113
3114 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3115
3116
3117 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3118 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3119 @c
3120 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3121 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3122 @c function are executed without stopping.
3123
3124 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3125 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3126 switch statements, for loops, etc.
3127
3128 @kindex finish
3129 @item finish
3130 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3131 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3132
3133 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3134 ,Returning from a function}).
3135
3136 @kindex until
3137 @kindex u
3138 @item until
3139 @itemx u
3140 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3141 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3142 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3143 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3144 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3145 than the address of the jump.
3146
3147 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3148 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3149 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3150 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3151 through the next iteration.
3152
3153 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3154 stack frame.
3155
3156 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3157 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3158 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3159 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3160 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3161
3162 @example
3163 (@value{GDBP}) f
3164 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3165 206 expand_input();
3166 (@value{GDBP}) until
3167 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3168 @end example
3169
3170 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3171 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3172 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3173 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3174 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3175 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3176 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3177
3178 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3179 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3180 argument.
3181
3182 @item until @var{location}
3183 @itemx u @var{location}
3184 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3185 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3186 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3187 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3188 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3189
3190 @kindex stepi
3191 @kindex si
3192 @item stepi
3193 @itemx si
3194 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3195
3196 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3197 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3198 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3199 Display,, Automatic display}.
3200
3201 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3202
3203 @need 750
3204 @kindex nexti
3205 @kindex ni
3206 @item nexti
3207 @itemx ni
3208 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3209 proceed until the function returns.
3210
3211 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3212 @end table
3213
3214 @node Signals
3215 @section Signals
3216 @cindex signals
3217
3218 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3219 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3220 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3221 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3222 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3223 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3224 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3225 requested an alarm).
3226
3227 @cindex fatal signals
3228 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3229 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3230 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3231 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3232 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3233 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3234
3235 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3236 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3237 signal.
3238
3239 @cindex handling signals
3240 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3241 (so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3242 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3243 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3244
3245 @table @code
3246 @kindex info signals
3247 @item info signals
3248 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3249 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3250 the defined types of signals.
3251
3252 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3253
3254 @kindex handle
3255 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3256 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3257 be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3258 beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3259 @end table
3260
3261 @c @group
3262 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3263 Their full names are:
3264
3265 @table @code
3266 @item nostop
3267 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3268 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3269
3270 @item stop
3271 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3272 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3273
3274 @item print
3275 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3276
3277 @item noprint
3278 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3279 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3280
3281 @item pass
3282 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3283 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3284 and not handled.
3285
3286 @item nopass
3287 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3288 @end table
3289 @c @end group
3290
3291 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3292 program until you
3293 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3294 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3295 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3296 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3297 program sees that signal when you continue.
3298
3299 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3300 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3301 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3302 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3303 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3304 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3305 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3306 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3307 program a signal}.
3308
3309 @node Thread Stops
3310 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3311
3312 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3313 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3314 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3315
3316 @table @code
3317 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3318 @cindex thread breakpoints
3319 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3320 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3321 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3322 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3323 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3324
3325 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3326 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3327 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3328 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3329 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3330
3331 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3332 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3333 program.
3334
3335 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3336 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3337 breakpoint condition, like this:
3338
3339 @smallexample
3340 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3341 @end smallexample
3342
3343 @end table
3344
3345 @cindex stopped threads
3346 @cindex threads, stopped
3347 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3348 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3349 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3350 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3351 underfoot.
3352
3353 @cindex continuing threads
3354 @cindex threads, continuing
3355 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3356 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3357 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3358
3359 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3360 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3361 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3362 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3363 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3364 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3365 stops.
3366
3367 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3368 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3369 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3370 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3371
3372 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3373 thread to run.
3374
3375 @table @code
3376 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3377 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3378 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3379 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3380 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3381 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3382 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3383 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3384 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3385 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3386 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3387 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3388
3389 @item show scheduler-locking
3390 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3391 @end table
3392
3393
3394 @node Stack
3395 @chapter Examining the Stack
3396
3397 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3398 stopped and how it got there.
3399
3400 @cindex call stack
3401 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3402 is generated.
3403 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3404 the arguments of the call,
3405 and the local variables of the function being called.
3406 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3407 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3408 stack}.
3409
3410 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3411 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3412
3413 @cindex selected frame
3414 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3415 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3416 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3417 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3418 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3419 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3420
3421 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3422 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3423 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3424
3425 @menu
3426 * Frames:: Stack frames
3427 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3428 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3429 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3430
3431 @end menu
3432
3433 @node Frames
3434 @section Stack frames
3435
3436 @cindex frame, definition
3437 @cindex stack frame
3438 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3439 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3440 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3441 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3442 which the function is executing.
3443
3444 @cindex initial frame
3445 @cindex outermost frame
3446 @cindex innermost frame
3447 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3448 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3449 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3450 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3451 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3452 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3453 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3454 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3455
3456 @cindex frame pointer
3457 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3458 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3459 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3460 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3461 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3462 going on in that frame.
3463
3464 @cindex frame number
3465 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3466 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3467 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3468 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3469 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3470
3471 @c below produces an acceptable overful hbox. --mew 13aug1993
3472 @cindex frameless execution
3473 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3474 without stack frames. (For example, the @code{@value{GCC}} option
3475 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} generates functions without a frame.)
3476 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3477 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3478 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3479 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3480 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3481 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3482 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3483
3484 @table @code
3485 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3486 @item frame @var{args}
3487 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3488 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3489 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3490 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3491
3492 @kindex select-frame
3493 @item select-frame
3494 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3495 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3496 @code{frame}.
3497 @end table
3498
3499 @node Backtrace
3500 @section Backtraces
3501
3502 @cindex backtraces
3503 @cindex tracebacks
3504 @cindex stack traces
3505 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3506 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3507 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3508 stack.
3509
3510 @table @code
3511 @kindex backtrace
3512 @kindex bt
3513 @item backtrace
3514 @itemx bt
3515 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3516 frames in the stack.
3517
3518 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3519 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3520
3521 @item backtrace @var{n}
3522 @itemx bt @var{n}
3523 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3524
3525 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3526 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3527 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3528 @end table
3529
3530 @kindex where
3531 @kindex info stack
3532 @kindex info s
3533 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3534 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3535
3536 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3537 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3538 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3539 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3540 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3541 line number.
3542
3543 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3544 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3545
3546 @smallexample
3547 @group
3548 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3549 at builtin.c:993
3550 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3551 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3552 at macro.c:71
3553 (More stack frames follow...)
3554 @end group
3555 @end smallexample
3556
3557 @noindent
3558 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3559 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3560 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3561
3562 @node Selection
3563 @section Selecting a frame
3564
3565 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3566 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3567 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3568 of the stack frame just selected.
3569
3570 @table @code
3571 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3572 @kindex f
3573 @item frame @var{n}
3574 @itemx f @var{n}
3575 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3576 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3577 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3578 @code{main}.
3579
3580 @item frame @var{addr}
3581 @itemx f @var{addr}
3582 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3583 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3584 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3585 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3586 switches between them.
3587
3588 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3589 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3590
3591 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3592 pointer and a program counter.
3593
3594 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3595 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3596 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3597 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3598 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3599
3600 @kindex up
3601 @item up @var{n}
3602 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3603 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3604 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3605
3606 @kindex down
3607 @kindex do
3608 @item down @var{n}
3609 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3610 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3611 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3612 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3613 @end table
3614
3615 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3616 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3617 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3618 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3619
3620 @need 1000
3621 For example:
3622
3623 @smallexample
3624 @group
3625 (@value{GDBP}) up
3626 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3627 at env.c:10
3628 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3629 @end group
3630 @end smallexample
3631
3632 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3633 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3634 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3635
3636 @table @code
3637 @kindex down-silently
3638 @kindex up-silently
3639 @item up-silently @var{n}
3640 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3641 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3642 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3643 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3644 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3645 distracting.
3646 @end table
3647
3648 @node Frame Info
3649 @section Information about a frame
3650
3651 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3652 stack frame.
3653
3654 @table @code
3655 @item frame
3656 @itemx f
3657 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3658 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3659 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3660 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3661 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3662
3663 @kindex info frame
3664 @kindex info f
3665 @item info frame
3666 @itemx info f
3667 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3668 including:
3669
3670 @itemize @bullet
3671 @item
3672 the address of the frame
3673 @item
3674 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3675 @item
3676 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3677 @item
3678 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3679 @item
3680 the address of the frame's arguments
3681 @item
3682 the address of the frame's local variables
3683 @item
3684 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3685 @item
3686 which registers were saved in the frame
3687 @end itemize
3688
3689 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
3690 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3691 the usual conventions.
3692
3693 @item info frame @var{addr}
3694 @itemx info f @var{addr}
3695 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3696 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3697 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3698 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3699 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3700
3701 @kindex info args
3702 @item info args
3703 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3704
3705 @item info locals
3706 @kindex info locals
3707 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3708 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3709 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3710
3711 @kindex info catch
3712 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3713 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
3714 @item info catch
3715 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3716 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3717 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3718 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3719 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
3720
3721 @end table
3722
3723
3724 @node Source
3725 @chapter Examining Source Files
3726
3727 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3728 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3729 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3730 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3731 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3732 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3733 source files by explicit command.
3734
3735 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
3736 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
3737 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
3738
3739 @menu
3740 * List:: Printing source lines
3741 * Search:: Searching source files
3742 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3743 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3744 @end menu
3745
3746 @node List
3747 @section Printing source lines
3748
3749 @kindex list
3750 @kindex l
3751 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3752 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3753 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3754
3755 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3756
3757 @table @code
3758 @item list @var{linenum}
3759 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3760 current source file.
3761
3762 @item list @var{function}
3763 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3764 @var{function}.
3765
3766 @item list
3767 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3768 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3769 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3770 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3771 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3772
3773 @item list -
3774 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3775 @end table
3776
3777 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3778 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3779
3780 @table @code
3781 @kindex set listsize
3782 @item set listsize @var{count}
3783 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3784 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3785
3786 @kindex show listsize
3787 @item show listsize
3788 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3789 @end table
3790
3791 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3792 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
3793 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
3794 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
3795 each repetition moves up in the source file.
3796
3797 @cindex linespec
3798 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
3799 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
3800 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3801 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
3802
3803 @table @code
3804 @item list @var{linespec}
3805 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
3806
3807 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
3808 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
3809 linespecs.
3810
3811 @item list ,@var{last}
3812 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
3813
3814 @item list @var{first},
3815 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
3816
3817 @item list +
3818 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
3819
3820 @item list -
3821 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3822
3823 @item list
3824 As described in the preceding table.
3825 @end table
3826
3827 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
3828 kinds of linespec.
3829
3830 @table @code
3831 @item @var{number}
3832 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
3833 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
3834 the same source file as the first linespec.
3835
3836 @item +@var{offset}
3837 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
3838 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
3839 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
3840 first linespec.
3841
3842 @item -@var{offset}
3843 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
3844
3845 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
3846 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
3847
3848 @item @var{function}
3849 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
3850 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
3851
3852 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
3853 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
3854 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
3855 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
3856 identically named functions in different source files.
3857
3858 @item *@var{address}
3859 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
3860 @var{address} may be any expression.
3861 @end table
3862
3863 @node Search
3864 @section Searching source files
3865 @cindex searching
3866 @kindex reverse-search
3867
3868 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
3869 regular expression.
3870
3871 @table @code
3872 @kindex search
3873 @kindex forward-search
3874 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
3875 @itemx search @var{regexp}
3876 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
3877 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
3878 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
3879 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
3880 @code{fo}.
3881
3882 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
3883 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
3884 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
3885 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
3886 this command as @code{rev}.
3887 @end table
3888
3889 @node Source Path
3890 @section Specifying source directories
3891
3892 @cindex source path
3893 @cindex directories for source files
3894 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
3895 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
3896 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
3897 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
3898 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
3899 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
3900 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
3901 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
3902 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
3903 path.
3904
3905 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
3906 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
3907 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
3908 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
3909 last resort.
3910
3911 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
3912 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
3913 each line is in the file.
3914
3915 @kindex directory
3916 @kindex dir
3917 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
3918 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
3919 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
3920
3921 @table @code
3922 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
3923 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
3924 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
3925 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
3926 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
3927 part of absolute file names) or
3928 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
3929 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
3930
3931 @kindex cdir
3932 @kindex cwd
3933 @kindex $cdir
3934 @kindex $cwd
3935 @cindex compilation directory
3936 @cindex current directory
3937 @cindex working directory
3938 @cindex directory, current
3939 @cindex directory, compilation
3940 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
3941 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
3942 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
3943 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
3944 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
3945 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
3946
3947 @item directory
3948 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
3949
3950 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
3951 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
3952
3953 @item show directories
3954 @kindex show directories
3955 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
3956 @end table
3957
3958 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
3959 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
3960 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
3961
3962 @enumerate
3963 @item
3964 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
3965
3966 @item
3967 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
3968 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
3969 directories in one command.
3970 @end enumerate
3971
3972 @node Machine Code
3973 @section Source and machine code
3974
3975 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
3976 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
3977 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
3978 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
3979 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
3980 well as hex.
3981
3982 @table @code
3983 @kindex info line
3984 @item info line @var{linespec}
3985 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
3986 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
3987 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
3988 source lines}).
3989 @end table
3990
3991 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
3992 the object code for the first line of function
3993 @code{m4_changequote}:
3994
3995 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
3996 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
3997 @smallexample
3998 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changecom
3999 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4000 @end smallexample
4001
4002 @noindent
4003 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4004 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4005 @smallexample
4006 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4007 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4008 @end smallexample
4009
4010 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4011 @kindex x@r{, and }@code{info line}
4012 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4013 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4014 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4015 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4016 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4017 variables}).
4018
4019 @table @code
4020 @kindex disassemble
4021 @cindex assembly instructions
4022 @cindex instructions, assembly
4023 @cindex machine instructions
4024 @cindex listing machine instructions
4025 @item disassemble
4026 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4027 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4028 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4029 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4030 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4031 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4032 @end table
4033
4034 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4035 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4036
4037 @smallexample
4038 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4039 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4040 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4041 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4042 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4043 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4044 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4045 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4046 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4047 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4048 End of assembler dump.
4049 @end smallexample
4050
4051 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4052 mnemonics or other syntax.
4053
4054 @table @code
4055 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4056 @cindex assembly instructions
4057 @cindex instructions, assembly
4058 @cindex machine instructions
4059 @cindex listing machine instructions
4060 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4061 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4062 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4063 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4064 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4065
4066 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4067 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4068 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4069 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4070 @end table
4071
4072
4073 @node Data
4074 @chapter Examining Data
4075
4076 @cindex printing data
4077 @cindex examining data
4078 @kindex print
4079 @kindex inspect
4080 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4081 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4082 @c different window or something like that.
4083 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4084 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4085 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4086 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4087 Different Languages}).
4088
4089 @table @code
4090 @item print @var{expr}
4091 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4092 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4093 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4094 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4095 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4096 formats}.
4097
4098 @item print
4099 @itemx print /@var{f}
4100 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4101 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4102 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4103 @end table
4104
4105 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4106 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4107 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4108
4109 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4110 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4111 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4112 Table}.
4113
4114 @menu
4115 * Expressions:: Expressions
4116 * Variables:: Program variables
4117 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4118 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4119 * Memory:: Examining memory
4120 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4121 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4122 * Value History:: Value history
4123 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4124 * Registers:: Registers
4125 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4126 @end menu
4127
4128 @node Expressions
4129 @section Expressions
4130
4131 @cindex expressions
4132 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4133 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4134 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4135 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4136 and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4137 by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4138
4139 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4140 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4141 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4142 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4143
4144 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4145 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4146 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4147 languages.
4148
4149 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4150 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4151
4152 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4153 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4154 at that address in memory.
4155 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4156
4157 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4158 to programming languages:
4159
4160 @table @code
4161 @item @@
4162 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4163 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4164
4165 @item ::
4166 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4167 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4168
4169 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4170 @cindex type casting memory
4171 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4172 @cindex casts, to view memory
4173 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4174 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4175 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4176 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4177 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4178 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4179 @end table
4180
4181 @node Variables
4182 @section Program variables
4183
4184 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4185 in your program.
4186
4187 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4188 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4189
4190 @itemize @bullet
4191 @item
4192 global (or file-static)
4193 @end itemize
4194
4195 @noindent or
4196
4197 @itemize @bullet
4198 @item
4199 visible according to the scope rules of the
4200 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4201 @end itemize
4202
4203 @noindent This means that in the function
4204
4205 @example
4206 foo (a)
4207 int a;
4208 @{
4209 bar (a);
4210 @{
4211 int b = test ();
4212 bar (b);
4213 @}
4214 @}
4215 @end example
4216
4217 @noindent
4218 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4219 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4220 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4221 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4222
4223 @cindex variable name conflict
4224 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4225 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4226 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4227 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4228 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4229 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4230 using the colon-colon notation:
4231
4232 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4233 @iftex
4234 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4235 @kindex ::
4236 @end iftex
4237 @example
4238 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4239 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4240 @end example
4241
4242 @noindent
4243 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4244 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4245 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4246 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4247
4248 @example
4249 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4250 @end example
4251
4252 @cindex C++ scope resolution
4253 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4254 use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4255 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4256 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4257 @c conflict?? --mew
4258
4259 @cindex wrong values
4260 @cindex variable values, wrong
4261 @quotation
4262 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4263 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4264 scope, and just before exit.
4265 @end quotation
4266 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4267 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4268 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4269 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4270 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4271 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4272 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4273 variable definitions may be gone.
4274
4275 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4276 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4277 when compiling.
4278
4279 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4280 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4281 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4282 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4283 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4284 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4285 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4286
4287 @example
4288 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4289 @end example
4290
4291 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4292 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4293 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4294 supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4295 in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4296 to use DWARF-2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4297 debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4298 Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4299 information.
4300
4301
4302 @node Arrays
4303 @section Artificial arrays
4304
4305 @cindex artificial array
4306 @kindex @@
4307 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4308 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4309 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4310 program.
4311
4312 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4313 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4314 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4315 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4316 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4317 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4318 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4319 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4320 example. If a program says
4321
4322 @example
4323 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4324 @end example
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4328
4329 @example
4330 p *array@@len
4331 @end example
4332
4333 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4334 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4335 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4336 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4337 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4338
4339 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4340 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4341 The value need not be in memory:
4342 @example
4343 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4344 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4345 @end example
4346
4347 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4348 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4349 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4350 @example
4351 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4352 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4353 @end example
4354
4355 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4356 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4357 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4358 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4359 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4360 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4361 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4362 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4363 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4364 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4365
4366 @example
4367 set $i = 0
4368 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4369 @key{RET}
4370 @key{RET}
4371 @dots{}
4372 @end example
4373
4374 @node Output Formats
4375 @section Output formats
4376
4377 @cindex formatted output
4378 @cindex output formats
4379 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4380 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4381 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4382 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4383 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4384
4385 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4386 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4387 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4388 letters supported are:
4389
4390 @table @code
4391 @item x
4392 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4393 hexadecimal.
4394
4395 @item d
4396 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4397
4398 @item u
4399 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4400
4401 @item o
4402 Print as integer in octal.
4403
4404 @item t
4405 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4406 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4407 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4408 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4409
4410 @item a
4411 @cindex unknown address, locating
4412 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4413 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4414 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4415
4416 @example
4417 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4418 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4419 @end example
4420
4421 @item c
4422 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4423
4424 @item f
4425 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4426 using typical floating point syntax.
4427 @end table
4428
4429 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4430
4431 @example
4432 p/x $pc
4433 @end example
4434
4435 @noindent
4436 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4437 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4438
4439 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4440 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4441 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4442
4443 @node Memory
4444 @section Examining memory
4445
4446 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4447 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4448
4449 @cindex examining memory
4450 @table @code
4451 @kindex x
4452 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4453 @itemx x @var{addr}
4454 @itemx x
4455 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4456 @end table
4457
4458 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4459 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4460 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4461 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4462 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4463
4464 @table @r
4465 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4466 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4467 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4468 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4469 @c 4.1.2.
4470
4471 @item @var{f}, the display format
4472 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4473 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4474 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4475 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4476
4477 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4478 The unit size is any of
4479
4480 @table @code
4481 @item b
4482 Bytes.
4483 @item h
4484 Halfwords (two bytes).
4485 @item w
4486 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4487 @item g
4488 Giant words (eight bytes).
4489 @end table
4490
4491 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4492 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4493 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4494
4495 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4496 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4497 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4498 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4499 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4500 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4501 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4502 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4503 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4504 a value from memory).
4505 @end table
4506
4507 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4508 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4509 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4510 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4511 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4512
4513 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4514 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4515 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4516 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4517 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4518
4519 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4520 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4521 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4522 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4523 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4524 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4525
4526 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4527 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4528 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4529 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4530 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4531 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4532 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4533
4534 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4535 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4536 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4537 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4538 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4539 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4540 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4541 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4542 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4543
4544 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4545 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4546 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4547
4548 @node Auto Display
4549 @section Automatic display
4550 @cindex automatic display
4551 @cindex display of expressions
4552
4553 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4554 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4555 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4556 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4557 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4558 The automatic display looks like this:
4559
4560 @example
4561 2: foo = 38
4562 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4563 @end example
4564
4565 @noindent
4566 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4567 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4568 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4569 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4570 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4571 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4572 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4573
4574 @table @code
4575 @kindex display
4576 @item display @var{expr}
4577 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4578 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4579
4580 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4581
4582 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4583 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4584 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4585 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4586 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4587
4588 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4589 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4590 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4591 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4592 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4593 @end table
4594
4595 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4596 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4597 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4598
4599 @table @code
4600 @kindex delete display
4601 @kindex undisplay
4602 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4603 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4604 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4605
4606 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4607 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4608
4609 @kindex disable display
4610 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4611 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4612 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4613 enabled again later.
4614
4615 @kindex enable display
4616 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4617 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4618 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4619
4620 @item display
4621 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4622 done when your program stops.
4623
4624 @kindex info display
4625 @item info display
4626 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4627 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4628 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4629 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4630 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4631 @end table
4632
4633 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4634 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4635 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4636 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4637 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4638 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4639 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4640 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4641 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4642 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4643
4644 @node Print Settings
4645 @section Print settings
4646
4647 @cindex format options
4648 @cindex print settings
4649 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4650 and symbols are printed.
4651
4652 @noindent
4653 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4654
4655 @table @code
4656 @kindex set print address
4657 @item set print address
4658 @itemx set print address on
4659 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4660 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4661 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4662 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4663 @code{set print address on}:
4664
4665 @smallexample
4666 @group
4667 (@value{GDBP}) f
4668 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4669 at input.c:530
4670 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4671 @end group
4672 @end smallexample
4673
4674 @item set print address off
4675 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4676 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4677
4678 @smallexample
4679 @group
4680 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4681 (@value{GDBP}) f
4682 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4683 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4684 @end group
4685 @end smallexample
4686
4687 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4688 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4689 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4690 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4691
4692 @kindex show print address
4693 @item show print address
4694 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4695 @end table
4696
4697 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4698 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4699 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4700 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4701 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4702 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4703 it prints a symbolic address:
4704
4705 @table @code
4706 @kindex set print symbol-filename
4707 @item set print symbol-filename on
4708 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4709 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4710
4711 @item set print symbol-filename off
4712 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4713 default.
4714
4715 @kindex show print symbol-filename
4716 @item show print symbol-filename
4717 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4718 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4719 @end table
4720
4721 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4722 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4723 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4724
4725 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4726 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4727
4728 @table @code
4729 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4730 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4731 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4732 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4733 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4734 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4735
4736 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4737 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
4738 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4739 symbolic address.
4740 @end table
4741
4742 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4743 @cindex pointer, finding referent
4744 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4745 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4746 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4747 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4748 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4749 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4750
4751 @example
4752 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4753 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4754 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4755 @end example
4756
4757 @quotation
4758 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4759 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4760 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4761 @end quotation
4762
4763 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4764
4765 @table @code
4766 @kindex set print array
4767 @item set print array
4768 @itemx set print array on
4769 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4770 but uses more space. The default is off.
4771
4772 @item set print array off
4773 Return to compressed format for arrays.
4774
4775 @kindex show print array
4776 @item show print array
4777 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4778 arrays.
4779
4780 @kindex set print elements
4781 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4782 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4783 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4784 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4785 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
4786 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
4787 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4788
4789 @kindex show print elements
4790 @item show print elements
4791 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4792 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4793
4794 @kindex set print null-stop
4795 @item set print null-stop
4796 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
4797 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
4798 contain only short strings.
4799 The default is off.
4800
4801 @kindex set print pretty
4802 @item set print pretty on
4803 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
4804 per line, like this:
4805
4806 @smallexample
4807 @group
4808 $1 = @{
4809 next = 0x0,
4810 flags = @{
4811 sweet = 1,
4812 sour = 1
4813 @},
4814 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
4815 @}
4816 @end group
4817 @end smallexample
4818
4819 @item set print pretty off
4820 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
4821
4822 @smallexample
4823 @group
4824 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
4825 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
4826 @end group
4827 @end smallexample
4828
4829 @noindent
4830 This is the default format.
4831
4832 @kindex show print pretty
4833 @item show print pretty
4834 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
4835
4836 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
4837 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
4838 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
4839 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
4840 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
4841 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
4842 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
4843
4844 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
4845 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
4846 international character sets, and is the default.
4847
4848 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
4849 @item show print sevenbit-strings
4850 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
4851
4852 @kindex set print union
4853 @item set print union on
4854 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
4855 is the default setting.
4856
4857 @item set print union off
4858 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
4859
4860 @kindex show print union
4861 @item show print union
4862 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
4863 structures.
4864
4865 For example, given the declarations
4866
4867 @smallexample
4868 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
4869 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
4870 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
4871 Bug_forms;
4872
4873 struct thing @{
4874 Species it;
4875 union @{
4876 Tree_forms tree;
4877 Bug_forms bug;
4878 @} form;
4879 @};
4880
4881 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
4882 @end smallexample
4883
4884 @noindent
4885 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
4886
4887 @smallexample
4888 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
4889 @end smallexample
4890
4891 @noindent
4892 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
4893
4894 @smallexample
4895 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
4896 @end smallexample
4897 @end table
4898
4899 @need 1000
4900 @noindent
4901 These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
4902
4903 @table @code
4904 @cindex demangling
4905 @kindex set print demangle
4906 @item set print demangle
4907 @itemx set print demangle on
4908 Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
4909 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
4910 linkage. The default is on.
4911
4912 @kindex show print demangle
4913 @item show print demangle
4914 Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
4915
4916 @kindex set print asm-demangle
4917 @item set print asm-demangle
4918 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
4919 Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
4920 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
4921 The default is off.
4922
4923 @kindex show print asm-demangle
4924 @item show print asm-demangle
4925 Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
4926 or demangled form.
4927
4928 @kindex set demangle-style
4929 @cindex C++ symbol decoding style
4930 @cindex symbol decoding style, C++
4931 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
4932 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
4933 represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
4934
4935 @table @code
4936 @item auto
4937 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
4938
4939 @item gnu
4940 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
4941 This is the default.
4942
4943 @item hp
4944 Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
4945
4946 @item lucid
4947 Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
4948
4949 @item arm
4950 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
4951 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
4952 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
4953 require further enhancement to permit that.
4954
4955 @end table
4956 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
4957
4958 @kindex show demangle-style
4959 @item show demangle-style
4960 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
4961
4962 @kindex set print object
4963 @item set print object
4964 @itemx set print object on
4965 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
4966 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
4967 the virtual function table.
4968
4969 @item set print object off
4970 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
4971 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
4972
4973 @kindex show print object
4974 @item show print object
4975 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
4976
4977 @kindex set print static-members
4978 @item set print static-members
4979 @itemx set print static-members on
4980 Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
4981
4982 @item set print static-members off
4983 Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
4984
4985 @kindex show print static-members
4986 @item show print static-members
4987 Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
4988
4989 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
4990 @kindex set print vtbl
4991 @item set print vtbl
4992 @itemx set print vtbl on
4993 Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
4994 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
4995 ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
4996
4997 @item set print vtbl off
4998 Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
4999
5000 @kindex show print vtbl
5001 @item show print vtbl
5002 Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5003 @end table
5004
5005 @node Value History
5006 @section Value history
5007
5008 @cindex value history
5009 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5010 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5011 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5012 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5013 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5014 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5015 symbol table.
5016
5017 @cindex @code{$}
5018 @cindex @code{$$}
5019 @cindex history number
5020 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5021 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5022 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5023 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5024 history number.
5025
5026 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5027 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5028 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5029 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5030 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5031 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5032 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5033
5034 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5035 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5036
5037 @example
5038 p *$
5039 @end example
5040
5041 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5042 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5043
5044 @example
5045 p *$.next
5046 @end example
5047
5048 @noindent
5049 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5050 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5051
5052 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5053 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5054
5055 @example
5056 print x
5057 set x=5
5058 @end example
5059
5060 @noindent
5061 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5062 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5063
5064 @table @code
5065 @kindex show values
5066 @item show values
5067 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5068 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5069 values} does not change the history.
5070
5071 @item show values @var{n}
5072 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5073
5074 @item show values +
5075 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5076 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5077 @end table
5078
5079 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5080 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5081
5082 @node Convenience Vars
5083 @section Convenience variables
5084
5085 @cindex convenience variables
5086 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5087 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5088 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5089 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5090 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5091
5092 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5093 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5094 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5095 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5096 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5097
5098 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5099 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5100 For example:
5101
5102 @example
5103 set $foo = *object_ptr
5104 @end example
5105
5106 @noindent
5107 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5108 @code{object_ptr}.
5109
5110 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5111 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5112 value with another assignment at any time.
5113
5114 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5115 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5116 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5117 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5118
5119 @table @code
5120 @kindex show convenience
5121 @item show convenience
5122 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5123 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5124 @end table
5125
5126 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5127 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5128 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5129
5130 @example
5131 set $i = 0
5132 print bar[$i++]->contents
5133 @end example
5134
5135 @noindent
5136 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5137
5138 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5139 values likely to be useful.
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex $_
5143 @item $_
5144 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5145 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5146 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5147 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5148 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5149 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5150 to the type of @code{$__}.
5151
5152 @kindex $__
5153 @item $__
5154 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5155 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5156 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5157
5158 @item $_exitcode
5159 @kindex $_exitcode
5160 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5161 the program being debugged terminates.
5162 @end table
5163
5164 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5165 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5166 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5167
5168 @node Registers
5169 @section Registers
5170
5171 @cindex registers
5172 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5173 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5174 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5175 your machine.
5176
5177 @table @code
5178 @kindex info registers
5179 @item info registers
5180 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5181 registers (in the selected stack frame).
5182
5183 @kindex info all-registers
5184 @cindex floating point registers
5185 @item info all-registers
5186 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5187 registers.
5188
5189 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5190 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5191 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5192 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5193 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5194 @end table
5195
5196 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5197 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5198 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5199 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5200 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5201 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5202 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5203 you could print the program counter in hex with
5204
5205 @example
5206 p/x $pc
5207 @end example
5208
5209 @noindent
5210 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5211
5212 @example
5213 x/i $pc
5214 @end example
5215
5216 @noindent
5217 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5218 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5219 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5220 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5221 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5222 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5223 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5224
5225 @example
5226 set $sp += 4
5227 @end example
5228
5229 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5230 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5231 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5232 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5233 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5234 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5235 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5236
5237 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5238 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5239 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5240 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5241 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5242 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5243 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5244
5245 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5246 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5247 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5248 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5249 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5250 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5251 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5252 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5253 prints the data in both formats.
5254
5255 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5256 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5257 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5258 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5259 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5260 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5261
5262 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5263 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5264 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5265 frame makes no difference.
5266
5267 @node Floating Point Hardware
5268 @section Floating point hardware
5269 @cindex floating point
5270
5271 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5272 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5273
5274 @table @code
5275 @kindex info float
5276 @item info float
5277 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5278 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5279 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5280 the ARM and x86 machines.
5281 @end table
5282
5283 @node Languages
5284 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5285 @cindex languages
5286
5287 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5288 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5289 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5290 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5291 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5292 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
5293
5294 @cindex working language
5295 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5296 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5297 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5298 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5299 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5300 language}.
5301
5302 @menu
5303 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
5304 * Show:: Displaying the language
5305 * Checks:: Type and range checks
5306 * Support:: Supported languages
5307 @end menu
5308
5309 @node Setting
5310 @section Switching between source languages
5311
5312 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5313 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5314 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5315 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5316 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5317 are printed, etc.
5318
5319 In addition to the working language, every source file that
5320 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5321 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5322 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5323 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5324 controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5325 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
5326 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5327 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5328 Displaying the language}.
5329
5330 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5331 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5332 another language. In that case, make the
5333 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5334 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5335 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5336
5337 @menu
5338 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5339 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5340 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5341 @end menu
5342
5343 @node Filenames
5344 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5345
5346 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5347 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5348
5349 @table @file
5350
5351 @item .c
5352 C source file
5353
5354 @item .C
5355 @itemx .cc
5356 @itemx .cp
5357 @itemx .cpp
5358 @itemx .cxx
5359 @itemx .c++
5360 C++ source file
5361
5362 @item .f
5363 @itemx .F
5364 Fortran source file
5365
5366 @item .ch
5367 @itemx .c186
5368 @itemx .c286
5369 CHILL source file.
5370
5371 @item .mod
5372 Modula-2 source file
5373
5374 @item .s
5375 @itemx .S
5376 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5377 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5378 @end table
5379
5380 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5381 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5382
5383 @node Manually
5384 @subsection Setting the working language
5385
5386 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5387 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5388 your program.
5389
5390 @kindex set language
5391 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5392 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5393 a language, such as
5394 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
5395 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5396
5397 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5398 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5399 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5400 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5401 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5402 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5403 command such as:
5404
5405 @example
5406 print a = b + c
5407 @end example
5408
5409 @noindent
5410 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5411 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5412 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5413 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
5414
5415 @node Automatically
5416 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5417
5418 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5419 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5420 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5421 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5422 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5423 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5424 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5425 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5426 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5427
5428 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5429 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5430 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5431 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5432 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5433
5434 @node Show
5435 @section Displaying the language
5436
5437 The following commands help you find out which language is the
5438 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5439
5440 @kindex show language
5441 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5442 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
5443 @table @code
5444 @item show language
5445 Display the current working language. This is the
5446 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5447 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5448
5449 @item info frame
5450 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5451 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5452 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5453 information listed here.
5454
5455 @item info source
5456 Display the source language of this source file.
5457 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5458 information listed here.
5459 @end table
5460
5461 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5462 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5463 with a language explicitly:
5464
5465 @kindex set extension-language
5466 @kindex info extensions
5467 @table @code
5468 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5469 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5470 the source language @var{language}.
5471
5472 @item info extensions
5473 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5474 @end table
5475
5476 @node Checks
5477 @section Type and range checking
5478
5479 @quotation
5480 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5481 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5482 section documents the intended facilities.
5483 @end quotation
5484 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5485
5486 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5487 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5488 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5489 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5490 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5491 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5492 errors when your program is running.
5493
5494 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5495 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5496 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5497 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5498 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5499 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5500 for the default settings of supported languages.
5501
5502 @menu
5503 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5504 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5505 @end menu
5506
5507 @cindex type checking
5508 @cindex checks, type
5509 @node Type Checking
5510 @subsection An overview of type checking
5511
5512 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5513 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5514 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5515 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5516
5517 @smallexample
5518 1 + 2 @result{} 3
5519 @exdent but
5520 @error{} 1 + 2.3
5521 @end smallexample
5522
5523 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5524 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5525
5526 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5527 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5528 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5529 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5530 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5531 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5532 also issues a warning.
5533
5534 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5535 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5536 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5537 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5538 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5539 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5540
5541 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5542 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5543 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5544 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5545 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5546 details on specific languages.
5547
5548 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5549
5550 @kindex set check@r{, type}
5551 @kindex set check type
5552 @kindex show check type
5553 @table @code
5554 @item set check type auto
5555 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5556 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5557 each language.
5558
5559 @item set check type on
5560 @itemx set check type off
5561 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5562 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5563 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
5564 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
5565 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5566
5567 @item set check type warn
5568 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5569 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5570 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5571 numbers and structures.
5572
5573 @item show type
5574 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5575 is setting it automatically.
5576 @end table
5577
5578 @cindex range checking
5579 @cindex checks, range
5580 @node Range Checking
5581 @subsection An overview of range checking
5582
5583 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5584 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5585 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5586 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5587 not exceed the bounds of the array.
5588
5589 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5590 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5591 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5592 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5593
5594 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5595 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5596 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5597 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5598 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5599 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5600
5601 @example
5602 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5603 @end example
5604
5605 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5606 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5607 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5608
5609 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5610
5611 @kindex set check@r{, range}
5612 @kindex set check range
5613 @kindex show check range
5614 @table @code
5615 @item set check range auto
5616 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5617 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5618 each language.
5619
5620 @item set check range on
5621 @itemx set check range off
5622 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5623 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
5624 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5625 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
5626
5627 @item set check range warn
5628 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5629 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5630 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5631 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5632 systems).
5633
5634 @item show range
5635 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5636 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5637 @end table
5638
5639 @node Support
5640 @section Supported languages
5641
5642 @value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5643 @c This is false ...
5644 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5645 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5646 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5647 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5648 language.
5649
5650 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5651 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5652 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5653 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5654 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5655 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5656 language reference or tutorial.
5657
5658 @menu
5659 * C:: C and C++
5660 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
5661 * Chill:: Chill
5662 @end menu
5663
5664 @node C
5665 @subsection C and C++
5666
5667 @cindex C and C++
5668 @cindex expressions in C or C++
5669
5670 Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5671 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5672 together.
5673
5674 @cindex C++
5675 @kindex g++
5676 @cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5677 The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5678 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5679 effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5680 C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5681 compiler (@code{aCC}).
5682
5683 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5684 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5685 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5686 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5687 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
5688
5689 @menu
5690 * C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5691 * C Constants:: C and C++ constants
5692 * C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
5693 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
5694 * C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
5695 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5696 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5697 @end menu
5698
5699 @node C Operators
5700 @subsubsection C and C++ operators
5701
5702 @cindex C and C++ operators
5703
5704 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5705 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5706 often defined on groups of types.
5707
5708 For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
5709
5710 @itemize @bullet
5711
5712 @item
5713 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5714 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
5715
5716 @item
5717 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5718 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
5719
5720 @item
5721 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
5722
5723 @item
5724 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
5725
5726 @end itemize
5727
5728 @noindent
5729 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5730 in order of increasing precedence:
5731
5732 @table @code
5733 @item ,
5734 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5735 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5736 expression being the last expression evaluated.
5737
5738 @item =
5739 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5740 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5741
5742 @item @var{op}=
5743 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5744 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
5745 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
5746 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5747 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5748
5749 @item ?:
5750 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5751 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5752 integral type.
5753
5754 @item ||
5755 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5756
5757 @item &&
5758 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5759
5760 @item |
5761 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5762
5763 @item ^
5764 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5765
5766 @item &
5767 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5768
5769 @item ==@r{, }!=
5770 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5771 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5772
5773 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5774 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5775 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5776 and non-zero for true.
5777
5778 @item <<@r{, }>>
5779 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
5780
5781 @item @@
5782 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5783
5784 @item +@r{, }-
5785 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5786 pointer types.
5787
5788 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5789 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
5790 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
5791 integral types.
5792
5793 @item ++@r{, }--
5794 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
5795 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
5796 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
5797 operation takes place.
5798
5799 @item *
5800 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
5801 @code{++}.
5802
5803 @item &
5804 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
5805
5806 For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
5807 allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
5808 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
5809 where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
5810 stored.
5811
5812 @item -
5813 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
5814 precedence as @code{++}.
5815
5816 @item !
5817 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5818 @code{++}.
5819
5820 @item ~
5821 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5822 @code{++}.
5823
5824
5825 @item .@r{, }->
5826 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
5827 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
5828 pointer based on the stored type information.
5829 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
5830
5831 @item .*@r{, }->*
5832 Dereferences of pointers to members.
5833
5834 @item []
5835 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
5836 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5837
5838 @item ()
5839 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5840
5841 @item ::
5842 C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
5843 and @code{class} types.
5844
5845 @item ::
5846 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
5847 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
5848 above.
5849 @end table
5850
5851 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
5852 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
5853 predefined meaning.
5854
5855 @menu
5856 * C Constants::
5857 @end menu
5858
5859 @node C Constants
5860 @subsubsection C and C++ constants
5861
5862 @cindex C and C++ constants
5863
5864 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
5865 following ways:
5866
5867 @itemize @bullet
5868 @item
5869 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
5870 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
5871 a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
5872 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
5873 @code{long} value.
5874
5875 @item
5876 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
5877 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
5878 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
5879 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
5880 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
5881 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
5882 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
5883 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
5884 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
5885 constant.
5886
5887 @item
5888 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
5889 integral equivalents.
5890
5891 @item
5892 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
5893 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
5894 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
5895 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
5896 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
5897 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
5898 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
5899 @samp{\n} for newline.
5900
5901 @item
5902 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded
5903 by double quotes (@code{"}).
5904
5905 @item
5906 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
5907 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
5908
5909 @item
5910 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
5911 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
5912 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
5913 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
5914 @end itemize
5915
5916 @menu
5917 * C plus plus expressions::
5918 * C Defaults::
5919 * C Checks::
5920
5921 * Debugging C::
5922 @end menu
5923
5924 @node C plus plus expressions
5925 @subsubsection C++ expressions
5926
5927 @cindex expressions in C++
5928 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
5929
5930 @cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
5931 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
5932 @cindex C++ and object formats
5933 @cindex object formats and C++
5934 @cindex a.out and C++
5935 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
5936 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
5937 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
5938 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
5939 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
5940 @c periodically whether this has happened...
5941 @quotation
5942 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
5943 proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
5944 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
5945 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
5946 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
5947 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
5948 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
5949 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
5950 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
5951 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
5952 @end quotation
5953
5954 @enumerate
5955
5956 @cindex member functions
5957 @item
5958 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
5959
5960 @example
5961 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
5962 @end example
5963
5964 @kindex this
5965 @cindex namespace in C++
5966 @item
5967 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
5968 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
5969 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
5970 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
5971
5972 @cindex call overloaded functions
5973 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
5974 @cindex type conversions in C++
5975 @item
5976 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
5977 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
5978 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
5979 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
5980 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
5981 default arguments.
5982
5983 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
5984 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
5985 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
5986 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
5987 number of function arguments.
5988
5989 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
5990 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
5991 ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
5992
5993 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
5994 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
5995 @smallexample
5996 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
5997 @end smallexample
5998
5999 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
6000 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
6001
6002 @cindex reference declarations
6003 @item
6004 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
6005 them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6006 dereferenced.
6007
6008 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6009 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6010 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6011 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6012 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6013
6014 @item
6015 @value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6016 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6017 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6018 necessary, for example in an expression like
6019 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6020 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6021 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6022 @end enumerate
6023
6024 In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6025 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6026 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6027 invoking user-defined operators.
6028
6029 @node C Defaults
6030 @subsubsection C and C++ defaults
6031
6032 @cindex C and C++ defaults
6033
6034 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6035 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6036 C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6037 selects the working language.
6038
6039 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6040 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6041 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6042 these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6043 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6044 for further details.
6045
6046 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6047 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6048 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
6049
6050 @node C Checks
6051 @subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
6052
6053 @cindex C and C++ checks
6054
6055 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6056 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6057 considers two variables type equivalent if:
6058
6059 @itemize @bullet
6060 @item
6061 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6062 enumerated tag.
6063
6064 @item
6065 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6066 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6067
6068 @ignore
6069 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6070 @c FIXME--beers?
6071 @item
6072 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6073 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6074 compilers.)
6075 @end ignore
6076 @end itemize
6077
6078 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6079 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6080 that is not itself an array.
6081
6082 @node Debugging C
6083 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
6084
6085 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6086 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
6087 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6088 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
6089
6090 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6091 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6092 ,Expressions}.
6093
6094 @menu
6095 * Debugging C plus plus::
6096 @end menu
6097
6098 @node Debugging C plus plus
6099 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
6100
6101 @cindex commands for C++
6102
6103 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6104 designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6105
6106 @table @code
6107 @cindex break in overloaded functions
6108 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
6109 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6110 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6111 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6112
6113 @cindex overloading in C++
6114 @item rbreak @var{regex}
6115 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6116 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6117 classes.
6118 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6119
6120 @cindex C++ exception handling
6121 @item catch throw
6122 @itemx catch catch
6123 Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6124 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6125
6126 @cindex inheritance
6127 @item ptype @var{typename}
6128 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6129 @var{typename}.
6130 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6131
6132 @cindex C++ symbol display
6133 @item set print demangle
6134 @itemx show print demangle
6135 @itemx set print asm-demangle
6136 @itemx show print asm-demangle
6137 Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6138 displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6139 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6140
6141 @item set print object
6142 @itemx show print object
6143 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6144 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6145
6146 @item set print vtbl
6147 @itemx show print vtbl
6148 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6149 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6150 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6151 ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6152
6153 @kindex set overload-resolution
6154 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
6155 @item set overload-resolution on
6156 Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6157 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6158 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
6159 using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6160 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
6161 message.
6162
6163 @item set overload-resolution off
6164 Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6165 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6166 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6167 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6168 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6169 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6170 argument types.
6171
6172 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6173 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6174 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6175 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6176 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6177 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6178 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6179 @end table
6180
6181 @node Modula-2
6182 @subsection Modula-2
6183
6184 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
6185
6186 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6187 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6188 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6189 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6190 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6191 table.
6192
6193 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
6194 @menu
6195 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6196 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6197 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6198 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6199 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6200 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6201 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6202 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6203 @end menu
6204
6205 @node M2 Operators
6206 @subsubsection Operators
6207 @cindex Modula-2 operators
6208
6209 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6210 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6211 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6212 following definitions hold:
6213
6214 @itemize @bullet
6215
6216 @item
6217 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6218 their subranges.
6219
6220 @item
6221 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6222
6223 @item
6224 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6225
6226 @item
6227 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6228 @var{type}}.
6229
6230 @item
6231 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6232
6233 @item
6234 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6235
6236 @item
6237 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6238 @end itemize
6239
6240 @noindent
6241 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6242 increasing precedence:
6243
6244 @table @code
6245 @item ,
6246 Function argument or array index separator.
6247
6248 @item :=
6249 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6250 @var{value}.
6251
6252 @item <@r{, }>
6253 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6254 types.
6255
6256 @item <=@r{, }>=
6257 Less than, greater than, less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6258 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6259 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6260
6261 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6262 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6263 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6264 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6265 comment character.
6266
6267 @item IN
6268 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6269 Same precedence as @code{<}.
6270
6271 @item OR
6272 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6273
6274 @item AND@r{, }&
6275 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6276
6277 @item @@
6278 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6279
6280 @item +@r{, }-
6281 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6282 and difference on set types.
6283
6284 @item *
6285 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6286 on set types.
6287
6288 @item /
6289 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6290 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6291
6292 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
6293 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6294 precedence as @code{*}.
6295
6296 @item -
6297 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6298
6299 @item ^
6300 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6301
6302 @item NOT
6303 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6304 @code{^}.
6305
6306 @item .
6307 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6308 precedence as @code{^}.
6309
6310 @item []
6311 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6312
6313 @item ()
6314 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6315 as @code{^}.
6316
6317 @item ::@r{, }.
6318 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6319 @end table
6320
6321 @quotation
6322 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6323 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6324 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6325 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6326 @end quotation
6327
6328 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6329 @node Built-In Func/Proc
6330 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6331
6332 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6333 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6334
6335 @table @var
6336
6337 @item a
6338 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6339
6340 @item c
6341 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6342
6343 @item i
6344 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6345
6346 @item m
6347 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6348 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6349 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6350
6351 @item n
6352 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6353
6354 @item r
6355 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6356
6357 @item t
6358 represents a type.
6359
6360 @item v
6361 represents a variable.
6362
6363 @item x
6364 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6365 explanation of the function for details.
6366 @end table
6367
6368 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6369
6370 @table @code
6371 @item ABS(@var{n})
6372 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6373
6374 @item CAP(@var{c})
6375 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
6376 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
6377
6378 @item CHR(@var{i})
6379 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6380
6381 @item DEC(@var{v})
6382 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
6383
6384 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6385 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6386 new value.
6387
6388 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6389 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6390 set.
6391
6392 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
6393 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6394
6395 @item HIGH(@var{a})
6396 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6397
6398 @item INC(@var{v})
6399 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
6400
6401 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6402 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6403 new value.
6404
6405 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6406 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6407 there. Returns the new set.
6408
6409 @item MAX(@var{t})
6410 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6411
6412 @item MIN(@var{t})
6413 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6414
6415 @item ODD(@var{i})
6416 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6417
6418 @item ORD(@var{x})
6419 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
6420 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6421 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
6422 integral, character and enumerated types.
6423
6424 @item SIZE(@var{x})
6425 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6426
6427 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
6428 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6429
6430 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6431 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6432 @end table
6433
6434 @quotation
6435 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6436 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6437 an error.
6438 @end quotation
6439
6440 @cindex Modula-2 constants
6441 @node M2 Constants
6442 @subsubsection Constants
6443
6444 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6445 ways:
6446
6447 @itemize @bullet
6448
6449 @item
6450 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6451 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6452 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6453 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6454
6455 @item
6456 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6457 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6458 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6459 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6460 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6461 digits.
6462
6463 @item
6464 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6465 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
6466 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
6467 followed by a @samp{C}.
6468
6469 @item
6470 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6471 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6472 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6473 Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6474 sequences.
6475
6476 @item
6477 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6478
6479 @item
6480 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6481 @code{FALSE}.
6482
6483 @item
6484 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6485
6486 @item
6487 Set constants are not yet supported.
6488 @end itemize
6489
6490 @node M2 Defaults
6491 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6492 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
6493
6494 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6495 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
6496 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6497 selected the working language.
6498
6499 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6500 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
6501 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
6502 the language automatically}, for further details.
6503
6504 @node Deviations
6505 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6506 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6507
6508 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6509 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6510
6511 @itemize @bullet
6512 @item
6513 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6514 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6515 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6516 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6517 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6518 returned a pointer.)
6519
6520 @item
6521 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6522 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6523 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6524 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6525
6526 @item
6527 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6528 argument.
6529
6530 @item
6531 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6532 @end itemize
6533
6534 @node M2 Checks
6535 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6536 @cindex Modula-2 checks
6537
6538 @quotation
6539 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6540 range checking.
6541 @end quotation
6542 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6543
6544 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6545
6546 @itemize @bullet
6547 @item
6548 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6549 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6550
6551 @item
6552 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6553 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6554 @end itemize
6555
6556 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6557 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6558
6559 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6560 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6561
6562 @node M2 Scope
6563 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6564 @cindex scope
6565 @kindex .
6566 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6567 @ifinfo
6568 @kindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
6569 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6570 @end ifinfo
6571 @iftex
6572 @kindex ::
6573 @end iftex
6574
6575 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6576 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6577 similar syntax:
6578
6579 @example
6580
6581 @var{module} . @var{id}
6582 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
6583 @end example
6584
6585 @noindent
6586 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6587 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6588 identifier within your program, except another module.
6589
6590 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6591 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6592 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6593 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6594
6595 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6596 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6597 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6598 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6599 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6600 @var{module}.
6601
6602 @node GDB/M2
6603 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6604
6605 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6606 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6607 specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6608 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6609 apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6610 analogue in Modula-2.
6611
6612 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
6613 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
6614 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6615 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6616 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
6617 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
6618
6619 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6620 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6621 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
6622
6623 @node Chill
6624 @subsection Chill
6625
6626 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
6627 from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
6628 supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6629 likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6630 table.
6631
6632 @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6633 @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6634 This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
6635 of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6636
6637 @menu
6638 * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6639 * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
6640 * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
6641 * Chill type and range checks::
6642 * Chill defaults::
6643 @end menu
6644
6645 @node How modes are displayed
6646 @subsubsection How modes are displayed
6647
6648 The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
6649 with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
6650 slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6651 provided modes are:
6652
6653 @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6654 @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
6655 @table @code
6656 @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6657 @itemize @bullet
6658 @item
6659 @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6660 UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6661 @item
6662 @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6663 @item
6664 @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6665 @item
6666 @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6667 @smallexample
6668 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6669 type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6670 @end smallexample
6671 If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6672 @item
6673 @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by @code{type = <basemode>
6674 (<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}, where @code{<lower bound>, <upper
6675 bound>} can be of any discrete literal expression (e.g. set element
6676 names).
6677 @end itemize
6678
6679 @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6680 A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
6681 the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
6682 @smallexample
6683 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6684 type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6685 @end smallexample
6686
6687 @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6688 @itemize @bullet
6689 @item
6690 @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
6691 followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6692 @item
6693 @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6694 @end itemize
6695
6696 @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6697 The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6698 <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
6699 list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6700 the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
6701 all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6702
6703 @ignore
6704 @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6705 The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6706 type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6707 @end ignore
6708
6709 @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6710 @itemize @bullet
6711 @item
6712 @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by @code{EVENT (<event length>)},
6713 where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6714 @item
6715 @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)
6716 <buffer element mode>}, where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6717 @end itemize
6718
6719 @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6720 @itemize @bullet
6721 @item
6722 @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6723 @item
6724 @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6725 @end itemize
6726
6727 @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6728 Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6729
6730 @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6731 @itemize @bullet
6732 @item
6733 @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by @code{CHARS(<string
6734 length>)}, followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is
6735 a varying mode
6736 @item
6737 @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by @code{BOOLS(<string
6738 length>)}.
6739 @end itemize
6740
6741 @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6742 The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6743 followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6744 @smallexample
6745 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6746 type = ARRAY (1:42)
6747 ARRAY (1:20)
6748 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6749 @end smallexample
6750
6751 @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6752 The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
6753 list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6754 of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6755 OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
6756 of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6757 checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6758 always displays all variant fields.
6759 @smallexample
6760 (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6761 type = STRUCT (
6762 as x,
6763 bs x,
6764 CASE bs OF
6765 (karli):
6766 cs a
6767 (ott):
6768 ds x
6769 ESAC
6770 )
6771 @end smallexample
6772 @end table
6773
6774 @node Locations
6775 @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6776
6777 A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
6778
6779 A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
6780 the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
6781 Chill programs. How values are specified
6782 is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
6783
6784 The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
6785 display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
6786
6787 @smallexample
6788 set result := EXPR
6789 @end smallexample
6790
6791 @noindent
6792 This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
6793 is not available in @value{GDBN}).
6794
6795 Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
6796 value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
6797 mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
6798 represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
6799 value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
6800 operator @samp{->}.
6801
6802 Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by @code{@{ PROC
6803 (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6804 location>}. @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the
6805 parameter specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the
6806 address of the entry point.
6807
6808 @ignore
6809 Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
6810 fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
6811 the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
6812 implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
6813 na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
6814 <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
6815 @code{__proc_copy}.
6816
6817 Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
6818 the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
6819 like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
6820 mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
6821
6822 Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
6823 ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
6824 definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
6825 of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
6826 structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
6827 braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
6828 on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
6829 memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
6830 all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
6831 @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
6832 stuff ???)
6833 @smallexample
6834 (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
6835 [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
6836 @end smallexample
6837 @end ignore
6838
6839 Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
6840 (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
6841 certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
6842 and their Operations}.
6843
6844 A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
6845 location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
6846 name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
6847 have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
6848 checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
6849 therefore the result can be quite confusing.
6850
6851 @smallexample
6852 (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
6853 @end smallexample
6854
6855 @node Values and their Operations
6856 @subsubsection Values and their Operations
6857
6858 Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
6859 more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
6860 data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
6861 such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
6862 constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
6863 when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
6864 (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
6865 the values behind these locations.
6866
6867 This section describes how values have to be specified and which
6868 operations are legal to be used with such values.
6869
6870 @table @code
6871 @item Literal Values
6872 Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
6873 For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
6874 chapter 1.5.
6875 @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
6876 @c be converted to a @ref.
6877
6878 @ignore
6879 @itemize @bullet
6880 @item
6881 @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
6882 programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
6883 @item
6884 @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
6885 @item
6886 @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
6887 @code{'M'})
6888 @item
6889 @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
6890 mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
6891 comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
6892 @item
6893 @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
6894 emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
6895 procedure value or the empty instance value.
6896
6897 @item
6898 @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
6899 enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
6900 to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
6901 @item
6902 @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
6903 programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
6904 @item
6905 @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
6906 (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
6907 @end itemize
6908 @end ignore
6909
6910 @item Tuple Values
6911 A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
6912 name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
6913 unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
6914 @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
6915
6916 @itemize @bullet
6917 @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
6918 @item @emph{Array Tuple}
6919 @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
6920 Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
6921 same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
6922 @end itemize
6923
6924 @item String Element Value
6925 A string element value is specified by @code{<string value>(<index>)},
6926 where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
6927 value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
6928 the string.
6929
6930 @item String Slice Value
6931 A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
6932 spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
6933 expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
6934 @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
6935 The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
6936 string.
6937
6938 @item Array Element Values
6939 An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
6940 delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
6941
6942 @item Array Slice Values
6943 An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
6944 @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
6945 @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
6946 arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
6947 which is part of the specified array.
6948
6949 @item Structure Field Values
6950 A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
6951 name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
6952 in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
6953 corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
6954
6955 @item Procedure Call Value
6956 The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
6957 procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
6958 expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
6959 effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
6960
6961 Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
6962
6963 Values of time mode locations are represented by @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}.
6964
6965 @ignore
6966 This is not implemented yet:
6967 @item Built-in Value
6968 @noindent
6969 The following built in functions are provided:
6970
6971 @table @code
6972 @item @code{ADDR()}
6973 @item @code{NUM()}
6974 @item @code{PRED()}
6975 @item @code{SUCC()}
6976 @item @code{ABS()}
6977 @item @code{CARD()}
6978 @item @code{MAX()}
6979 @item @code{MIN()}
6980 @item @code{SIZE()}
6981 @item @code{UPPER()}
6982 @item @code{LOWER()}
6983 @item @code{LENGTH()}
6984 @item @code{SIN()}
6985 @item @code{COS()}
6986 @item @code{TAN()}
6987 @item @code{ARCSIN()}
6988 @item @code{ARCCOS()}
6989 @item @code{ARCTAN()}
6990 @item @code{EXP()}
6991 @item @code{LN()}
6992 @item @code{LOG()}
6993 @item @code{SQRT()}
6994 @end table
6995
6996 For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
6997 chapter 1.6.
6998 @end ignore
6999
7000 @item Zero-adic Operator Value
7001 The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7002 current active process.
7003
7004 @item Expression Values
7005 The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
7006 the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
7007 incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
7008 corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
7009 causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
7010 which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
7011 operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
7012
7013 @table @code
7014 @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
7015 @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7016 @itemx @code{NOT}
7017 Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
7018
7019 @item @code{=, /=}
7020 Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
7021
7022 @item @code{>, >=}
7023 @itemx @code{<, <=}
7024 Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
7025
7026 @item @code{+, -}
7027 @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
7028 Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
7029
7030 @item @code{-}
7031 Change sign operator.
7032
7033 @item @code{//}
7034 String concatenation operator.
7035
7036 @item @code{()}
7037 String repetition operator.
7038
7039 @item @code{->}
7040 Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7041 address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7042 location (@code{loc->}).
7043
7044 @item @code{OR, XOR}
7045 @itemx @code{AND}
7046 @itemx @code{NOT}
7047 Powerset and bitstring operators.
7048
7049 @item @code{>, >=}
7050 @itemx @code{<, <=}
7051 Powerset inclusion operators.
7052
7053 @item @code{IN}
7054 Membership operator.
7055 @end table
7056 @end table
7057
7058 @node Chill type and range checks
7059 @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7060
7061 @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
7062 of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
7063 complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
7064 equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
7065 structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7066
7067 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7068 index bounds and all built in procedures.
7069
7070 Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
7071 check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
7072 operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7073 functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7074 language specification.
7075
7076 All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7077 off}.
7078
7079 @ignore
7080 @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
7081 see last paragraph ?
7082 @end ignore
7083
7084 @node Chill defaults
7085 @subsubsection Chill defaults
7086
7087 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7088 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
7089 Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7090 selected the working language.
7091
7092 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7093 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
7094 working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
7095 the language automatically}, for further details.
7096
7097 @node Symbols
7098 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7099
7100 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
7101 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7102 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7103 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7104 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7105 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7106 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7107
7108 @cindex symbol names
7109 @cindex names of symbols
7110 @cindex quoting names
7111 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7112 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7113 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7114 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7115 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7116 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7117 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7118 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7119
7120 @example
7121 p 'foo.c'::x
7122 @end example
7123
7124 @noindent
7125 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7126
7127 @table @code
7128 @kindex info address
7129 @item info address @var{symbol}
7130 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7131 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7132 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7133 is always stored.
7134
7135 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7136 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7137 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7138
7139 @kindex whatis
7140 @item whatis @var{expr}
7141 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
7142 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7143 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7144 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7145
7146 @item whatis
7147 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7148
7149 @kindex ptype
7150 @item ptype @var{typename}
7151 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7152 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7153 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7154 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
7155
7156 @item ptype @var{expr}
7157 @itemx ptype
7158 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
7159 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7160 of just the name of the type.
7161
7162 For example, for this variable declaration:
7163
7164 @example
7165 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7166 @end example
7167
7168 @noindent
7169 the two commands give this output:
7170
7171 @example
7172 @group
7173 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7174 type = struct complex
7175 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7176 type = struct complex @{
7177 double real;
7178 double imag;
7179 @}
7180 @end group
7181 @end example
7182
7183 @noindent
7184 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7185 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7186
7187 @kindex info types
7188 @item info types @var{regexp}
7189 @itemx info types
7190 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
7191 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7192 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7193 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
7194 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
7195 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7196
7197 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7198 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7199 lists all source files where a type is defined.
7200
7201 @kindex info source
7202 @item info source
7203 Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7204 the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7205 it was written in.
7206
7207 @kindex info sources
7208 @item info sources
7209 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7210 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7211 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7212
7213 @kindex info functions
7214 @item info functions
7215 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7216
7217 @item info functions @var{regexp}
7218 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7219 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7220 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7221 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7222 start with @code{step}.
7223
7224 @kindex info variables
7225 @item info variables
7226 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7227 outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7228
7229 @item info variables @var{regexp}
7230 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7231 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7232 @var{regexp}.
7233
7234 @ignore
7235 This was never implemented.
7236 @kindex info methods
7237 @item info methods
7238 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7239 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7240 methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7241 specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7242 C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7243 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7244 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7245 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7246 @end ignore
7247
7248 @cindex reloading symbols
7249 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7250 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7251 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7252 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7253 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
7254
7255 @table @code
7256 @kindex set symbol-reloading
7257 @item set symbol-reloading on
7258 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7259 object file with a particular name is seen again.
7260
7261 @item set symbol-reloading off
7262 Do not replace symbol definitions when re-encountering object files of
7263 the same name. This is the default state; if you are not running on a
7264 system that permits automatically relinking modules, you should leave
7265 @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN} may discard symbols
7266 when linking large programs, that may contain several modules (from
7267 different directories or libraries) with the same name.
7268
7269 @kindex show symbol-reloading
7270 @item show symbol-reloading
7271 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7272 @end table
7273
7274 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7275 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
7276 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7277 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7278 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7279 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7280 another source file. The default is on.
7281
7282 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7283 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7284
7285 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
7286 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7287 is printed as follows:
7288 @smallexample
7289 @{<no data fields>@}
7290 @end smallexample
7291
7292 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7293 @item show opaque-type-resolution
7294 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
7295
7296 @kindex maint print symbols
7297 @cindex symbol dump
7298 @kindex maint print psymbols
7299 @cindex partial symbol dump
7300 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7301 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7302 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7303 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7304 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7305 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7306 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7307 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7308 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7309 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7310 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7311 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7312 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7313 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7314 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7315 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7316 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7317 @end table
7318
7319 @node Altering
7320 @chapter Altering Execution
7321
7322 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7323 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7324 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7325 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7326 program.
7327
7328 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7329 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7330 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
7331
7332 @menu
7333 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7334 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
7335 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
7336 * Returning:: Returning from a function
7337 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7338 * Patching:: Patching your program
7339 @end menu
7340
7341 @node Assignment
7342 @section Assignment to variables
7343
7344 @cindex assignment
7345 @cindex setting variables
7346 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7347 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7348
7349 @example
7350 print x=4
7351 @end example
7352
7353 @noindent
7354 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7355 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
7356 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7357 information on operators in supported languages.
7358
7359 @kindex set variable
7360 @cindex variables, setting
7361 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7362 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7363 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7364 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7365 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7366
7367 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7368 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7369 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7370 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7371 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7372 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7373 command @code{set width}:
7374
7375 @example
7376 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7377 type = double
7378 (@value{GDBP}) p width
7379 $4 = 13
7380 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7381 Invalid syntax in expression.
7382 @end example
7383
7384 @noindent
7385 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7386 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7387
7388 @example
7389 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7390 @end example
7391
7392 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7393 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7394 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7395 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7396 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7397 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7398
7399 @example
7400 @group
7401 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7402 type = double
7403 (@value{GDBP}) p g
7404 $1 = 1
7405 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
7406 (@value{GDBP}) p g
7407 $2 = 1
7408 (@value{GDBP}) r
7409 The program being debugged has been started already.
7410 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7411 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7412 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: Invalid bfd target.
7413 (@value{GDBP}) show g
7414 The current BFD target is "=4".
7415 @end group
7416 @end example
7417
7418 @noindent
7419 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7420 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7421 @code{g}, use
7422
7423 @example
7424 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7425 @end example
7426
7427 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7428 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7429 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7430 same length or shorter.
7431 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7432 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7433
7434 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7435 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7436 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7437 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7438 and representation in memory), and
7439
7440 @example
7441 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7442 @end example
7443
7444 @noindent
7445 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7446
7447 @node Jumping
7448 @section Continuing at a different address
7449
7450 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7451 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7452 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7453
7454 @table @code
7455 @kindex jump
7456 @item jump @var{linespec}
7457 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7458 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7459 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7460 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7461 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7462 breakpoints}.
7463
7464 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7465 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7466 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7467 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7468 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7469 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7470 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7471 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7472 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7473
7474 @item jump *@var{address}
7475 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7476 @end table
7477
7478 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
7479 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7480 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7481 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7482 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7483 example,
7484
7485 @example
7486 set $pc = 0x485
7487 @end example
7488
7489 @noindent
7490 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7491 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7492 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
7493
7494 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7495 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7496 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7497 detail.
7498
7499 @c @group
7500 @node Signaling
7501 @section Giving your program a signal
7502
7503 @table @code
7504 @kindex signal
7505 @item signal @var{signal}
7506 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7507 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7508 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7509 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7510
7511 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7512 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7513 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7514 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7515 signal.
7516
7517 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7518 after executing the command.
7519 @end table
7520 @c @end group
7521
7522 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7523 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7524 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7525 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7526 passes the signal directly to your program.
7527
7528
7529 @node Returning
7530 @section Returning from a function
7531
7532 @table @code
7533 @cindex returning from a function
7534 @kindex return
7535 @item return
7536 @itemx return @var{expression}
7537 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7538 command. If you give an
7539 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7540 value.
7541 @end table
7542
7543 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7544 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7545 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7546 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7547
7548 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7549 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7550 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7551 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7552 of functions.
7553
7554 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7555 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7556 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7557 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7558 selected stack frame returns naturally.
7559
7560 @node Calling
7561 @section Calling program functions
7562
7563 @cindex calling functions
7564 @kindex call
7565 @table @code
7566 @item call @var{expr}
7567 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7568 returned values.
7569 @end table
7570
7571 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7572 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7573 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7574 is printed and saved in the value history.
7575
7576 For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7577 specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7578 calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7579 method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7580 that have separate instruction and data spaces.
7581
7582 @node Patching
7583 @section Patching programs
7584
7585 @cindex patching binaries
7586 @cindex writing into executables
7587 @cindex writing into corefiles
7588
7589 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7590 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7591 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7592 patching your program's binary.
7593
7594 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7595 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7596 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7597 repairs.
7598
7599 @table @code
7600 @kindex set write
7601 @item set write on
7602 @itemx set write off
7603 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7604 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
7605 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7606
7607 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7608 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7609 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
7610
7611 @item show write
7612 @kindex show write
7613 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7614 as well as reading.
7615 @end table
7616
7617 @node GDB Files
7618 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7619
7620 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7621 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7622 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7623 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
7624
7625 @menu
7626 * Files:: Commands to specify files
7627 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7628 @end menu
7629
7630 @node Files
7631 @section Commands to specify files
7632
7633 @cindex symbol table
7634 @cindex core dump file
7635
7636 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7637 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7638 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7639 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
7640
7641 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7642 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7643 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7644 to specify new files are useful.
7645
7646 @table @code
7647 @cindex executable file
7648 @kindex file
7649 @item file @var{filename}
7650 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7651 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7652 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
7653 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7654 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7655 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7656 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7657 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7658
7659 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file
7660 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7661 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7662 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7663 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7664 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7665 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7666 for more information.
7667
7668 @item file
7669 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7670 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7671
7672 @kindex exec-file
7673 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7674 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7675 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7676 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7677 discard information on the executable file.
7678
7679 @kindex symbol-file
7680 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7681 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7682 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7683 table and program to run from the same file.
7684
7685 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7686 program's symbol table.
7687
7688 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7689 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7690 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7691 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7692 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7693
7694 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7695 executing it once.
7696
7697 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7698 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7699 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7700 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
7701 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7702 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7703 optimized code.
7704
7705 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7706 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7707 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7708 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7709 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7710
7711 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7712 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7713 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7714 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7715 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7716 warnings and messages}.)
7717
7718 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7719 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7720 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7721 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7722 in stabs format.
7723
7724 @kindex readnow
7725 @cindex reading symbols immediately
7726 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
7727 @kindex mapped
7728 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7729 @cindex saving symbol table
7730 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7731 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7732 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7733 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7734 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7735 entire symbol table available.
7736
7737 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7738 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7739 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7740 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7741 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7742 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7743 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7744 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7745
7746 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7747 file has all the symbol information for your program.
7748
7749 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7750 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7751 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7752 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7753 needed.
7754
7755 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7756 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7757 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
7758
7759 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7760 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7761 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7762 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7763 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7764 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
7765 @c files.
7766
7767 @kindex core
7768 @kindex core-file
7769 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7770 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
7771 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
7772 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
7773 executable file itself for other parts.
7774
7775 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
7776 to be used.
7777
7778 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7779 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
7780 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
7781 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
7782 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
7783
7784 @kindex add-symbol-file
7785 @cindex dynamic linking
7786 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
7787 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7788 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @var{data_address} @var{bss_address}
7789 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
7790 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table information
7791 from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command when @var{filename}
7792 has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) into the program that
7793 is running. @var{address} should be the memory address at which the
7794 file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure this out for itself.
7795 You can specify up to three addresses, in which case they are taken to be
7796 the addresses of the text, data, and bss segments respectively.
7797 For complicated cases, you can specify an arbitrary number of @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
7798 pairs, to give an explicit section name and base address for that section.
7799 You can specify any @var{address} as an expression.
7800
7801 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
7802 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
7803 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data thus
7804 read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data instead,
7805 use the @code{symbol-file} command.
7806
7807 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7808
7809 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
7810 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
7811 table information for @var{filename}.
7812
7813 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
7814 @item add-shared-symbol-file
7815 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
7816 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
7817 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
7818 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
7819
7820 @kindex section
7821 @item section
7822 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
7823 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
7824 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
7825 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
7826 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
7827 the sections and their addresses.
7828
7829 @kindex info files
7830 @kindex info target
7831 @item info files
7832 @itemx info target
7833 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
7834 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
7835 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
7836 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
7837 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
7838 current ones.
7839
7840 @end table
7841
7842 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
7843 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
7844 name and remembers it that way.
7845
7846 @cindex shared libraries
7847 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
7848 libraries.
7849
7850 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
7851 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
7852 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
7853 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
7854 debugging a core file).
7855
7856 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
7857 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
7858
7859 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
7860 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
7861 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
7862
7863 @table @code
7864 @kindex info sharedlibrary
7865 @kindex info share
7866 @item info share
7867 @itemx info sharedlibrary
7868 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
7869
7870 @kindex sharedlibrary
7871 @kindex share
7872 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
7873 @itemx share @var{regex}
7874 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
7875 Unix regular expression.
7876 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
7877 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
7878 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
7879 loaded.
7880 @end table
7881
7882 On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
7883 and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
7884 a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
7885
7886 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
7887 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
7888 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
7889 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
7890
7891 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
7892
7893 @table @code
7894 @kindex set auto-solib-add
7895 @item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
7896 Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
7897 nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
7898 automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
7899 linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
7900 the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
7901 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
7902 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
7903
7904 @kindex show auto-solib-add
7905 @item show auto-solib-add
7906 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
7907 @end table
7908
7909 @node Symbol Errors
7910 @section Errors reading symbol files
7911
7912 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
7913 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
7914 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
7915 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
7916 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
7917 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
7918 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
7919 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
7920 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
7921 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7922 messages}).
7923
7924 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
7925
7926 @table @code
7927 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
7928
7929 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
7930 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
7931 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
7932 in its outer scope blocks.
7933
7934 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
7935 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
7936 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
7937 function.
7938
7939 @item block at @var{address} out of order
7940
7941 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
7942 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
7943 do so.
7944
7945 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
7946 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
7947 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
7948 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7949 messages}.)
7950
7951 @item bad block start address patched
7952
7953 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
7954 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
7955 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
7956
7957 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
7958 starting on the previous source line.
7959
7960 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
7961
7962 @cindex foo
7963 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
7964 larger than the size of the string table.
7965
7966 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
7967 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
7968 with this name.
7969
7970 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
7971
7972 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
7973 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
7974 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
7975
7976 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
7977 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
7978 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7979 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
7980 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
7981 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
7982
7983 @item stub type has NULL name
7984
7985 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
7986
7987 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
7988 The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7989 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
7990 it.
7991
7992 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
7993
7994 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7995
7996 @end table
7997
7998 @node Targets
7999 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
8000
8001 @cindex debugging target
8002 @kindex target
8003
8004 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
8005
8006 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8007 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8008 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
8009 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8010 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
8011 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8012 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8013 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
8014
8015 @menu
8016 * Active Targets:: Active targets
8017 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
8018 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8019 * Remote:: Remote debugging
8020 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
8021
8022 @end menu
8023
8024 @node Active Targets
8025 @section Active targets
8026
8027 @cindex stacking targets
8028 @cindex active targets
8029 @cindex multiple targets
8030
8031 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
8032 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8033 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8034 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8035 a core file.
8036
8037 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8038 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8039 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8040 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8041 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8042 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8043 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8044 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8045 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
8046
8047 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
8048 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8049 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8050 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8051 process target is active.
8052
8053 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8054 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
8055 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
8056 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8057 process}).
8058
8059 @node Target Commands
8060 @section Commands for managing targets
8061
8062 @table @code
8063 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
8064 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8065 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8066 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8067 protocol of the target machine.
8068
8069 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8070 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8071 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
8072
8073 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8074 after executing the command.
8075
8076 @kindex help target
8077 @item help target
8078 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8079 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8080 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8081
8082 @item help target @var{name}
8083 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8084 select it.
8085
8086 @kindex set gnutarget
8087 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
8088 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
8089 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8090 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8091 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8092 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8093
8094 @quotation
8095 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8096 you must know the actual BFD name.
8097 @end quotation
8098
8099 @noindent
8100 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
8101
8102 @kindex show gnutarget
8103 @item show gnutarget
8104 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8105 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8106 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8107 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8108 @end table
8109
8110 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8111 configuration):
8112
8113 @table @code
8114 @kindex target exec
8115 @item target exec @var{program}
8116 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8117 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8118
8119 @kindex target core
8120 @item target core @var{filename}
8121 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8122 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
8123
8124 @kindex target remote
8125 @item target remote @var{dev}
8126 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8127 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8128 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
8129 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
8130 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8131 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8132
8133 @kindex target sim
8134 @item target sim
8135 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
8136 In general,
8137 @example
8138 target sim
8139 load
8140 run
8141 @end example
8142 @noindent
8143 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
8144 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
8145 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8146 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8147 Processors}.
8148
8149 @end table
8150
8151 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
8152
8153 @table @code
8154
8155 @kindex target nrom
8156 @item target nrom @var{dev}
8157 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8158
8159 @end table
8160
8161 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8162 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
8163
8164 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8165 once you've successfully established a connection.
8166
8167 @table @code
8168
8169 @kindex load @var{filename}
8170 @item load @var{filename}
8171 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8172 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8173 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8174 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8175 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8176 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8177
8178 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8179 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8180 target is @dots{}}''
8181
8182 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8183 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8184 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8185 specifies a fixed address.
8186 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8187
8188 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8189 @end table
8190
8191 @node Byte Order
8192 @section Choosing target byte order
8193
8194 @cindex choosing target byte order
8195 @cindex target byte order
8196 @kindex set endian big
8197 @kindex set endian little
8198 @kindex set endian auto
8199 @kindex show endian
8200
8201 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8202 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8203 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8204 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8205 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
8206 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
8207
8208 @table @code
8209 @kindex set endian big
8210 @item set endian big
8211 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8212
8213 @kindex set endian little
8214 @item set endian little
8215 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8216
8217 @kindex set endian auto
8218 @item set endian auto
8219 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8220 executable.
8221
8222 @item show endian
8223 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8224
8225 @end table
8226
8227 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8228 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8229 target system.
8230
8231 @node Remote
8232 @section Remote debugging
8233 @cindex remote debugging
8234
8235 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8236 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8237 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8238 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8239 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8240
8241 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8242 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8243 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8244 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8245 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8246 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8247
8248 Other remote targets may be available in your
8249 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
8250
8251 @menu
8252 * Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8253 @end menu
8254
8255 @node Remote Serial
8256 @subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8257
8258 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8259 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8260 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8261 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8262 program, you need:
8263
8264 @enumerate
8265 @item
8266 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8267 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8268 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
8269
8270 @item
8271 A C subroutine library to support your program's
8272 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
8273
8274 @item
8275 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8276 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8277 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8278 documentation.
8279 @end enumerate
8280
8281 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8282 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8283 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
8284
8285 @table @emph
8286 @item On the host,
8287 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8288 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8289 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8290
8291 @item On the target,
8292 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8293 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8294 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8295
8296 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8297 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8298 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8299 @end table
8300
8301 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8302 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8303 @sc{sparc} boards.
8304
8305 @cindex remote serial stub list
8306 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
8307
8308 @table @code
8309
8310 @item i386-stub.c
8311 @kindex i386-stub.c
8312 @cindex Intel
8313 @cindex i386
8314 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8315
8316 @item m68k-stub.c
8317 @kindex m68k-stub.c
8318 @cindex Motorola 680x0
8319 @cindex m680x0
8320 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8321
8322 @item sh-stub.c
8323 @kindex sh-stub.c
8324 @cindex Hitachi
8325 @cindex SH
8326 For Hitachi SH architectures.
8327
8328 @item sparc-stub.c
8329 @kindex sparc-stub.c
8330 @cindex Sparc
8331 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8332
8333 @item sparcl-stub.c
8334 @kindex sparcl-stub.c
8335 @cindex Fujitsu
8336 @cindex SparcLite
8337 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8338
8339 @end table
8340
8341 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8342 recently added stubs.
8343
8344 @menu
8345 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8346 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8347 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8348 * Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8349 * Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8350 * NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8351 @end menu
8352
8353 @node Stub Contents
8354 @subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8355
8356 @cindex remote serial stub
8357 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8358 subroutines:
8359
8360 @table @code
8361 @item set_debug_traps
8362 @kindex set_debug_traps
8363 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8364 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8365 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8366 beginning of your program.
8367
8368 @item handle_exception
8369 @kindex handle_exception
8370 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8371 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8372 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8373 run when a trap is triggered.
8374
8375 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8376 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8377 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8378 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
8379 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
8380 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8381 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8382 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8383 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8384 machine.
8385
8386 @item breakpoint
8387 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8388 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8389 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8390 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8391 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8392 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8393 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8394 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8395 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8396 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8397 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
8398
8399 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8400 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8401 start of your debugging session.
8402 @end table
8403
8404 @node Bootstrapping
8405 @subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8406
8407 @cindex remote stub, support routines
8408 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8409 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8410 debugging target machine.
8411
8412 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8413 serial port.
8414
8415 @table @code
8416 @item int getDebugChar()
8417 @kindex getDebugChar
8418 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8419 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8420 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8421
8422 @item void putDebugChar(int)
8423 @kindex putDebugChar
8424 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8425 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8426 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8427 @end table
8428
8429 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
8430 @cindex interrupting remote targets
8431 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8432 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8433 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8434 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8435 remote system to stop.
8436
8437 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8438 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8439 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8440 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8441
8442 Other routines you need to supply are:
8443
8444 @table @code
8445 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8446 @kindex exceptionHandler
8447 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8448 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8449 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8450 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8451 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8452 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8453 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8454 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8455 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8456 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8457 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8458 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8459 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8460
8461 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8462 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8463 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8464 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8465 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8466
8467 @item void flush_i_cache()
8468 @kindex flush_i_cache
8469 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
8470 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8471 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8472
8473 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8474 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8475 @end table
8476
8477 @noindent
8478 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8479
8480 @table @code
8481 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8482 @kindex memset
8483 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8484 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8485 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8486 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8487 @end table
8488
8489 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8490 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8491 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
8492 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
8493
8494
8495 @node Debug Session
8496 @subsubsection Putting it all together
8497
8498 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
8499 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8500 steps.
8501
8502 @enumerate
8503 @item
8504 Make sure you have the supporting low-level routines
8505 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8506 @display
8507 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8508 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8509 @end display
8510
8511 @item
8512 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8513
8514 @example
8515 set_debug_traps();
8516 breakpoint();
8517 @end example
8518
8519 @item
8520 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8521 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8522
8523 @example
8524 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8525 @end example
8526
8527 @noindent
8528 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
8529 function in your program; that function is called when
8530 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8531 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8532 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8533
8534 @item
8535 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8536 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8537
8538 @item
8539 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8540 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8541
8542 @item
8543 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8544 @c document that. FIXME.
8545 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8546 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8547
8548 @item
8549 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8550 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8551 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8552 of its pure text.
8553
8554 @item
8555 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
8556 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
8557 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8558 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8559 TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8560 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8561 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8562
8563 @example
8564 target remote /dev/ttyb
8565 @end example
8566
8567 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8568 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8569 @code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8570 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8571
8572 @example
8573 target remote manyfarms:2828
8574 @end example
8575 @end enumerate
8576
8577 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8578 step and continue the remote program.
8579
8580 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8581 command.
8582
8583 @cindex interrupting remote programs
8584 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
8585 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8586 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8587 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8588 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8589 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8590
8591 @example
8592 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8593 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8594 @end example
8595
8596 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8597 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8598 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8599 goes back to waiting.
8600
8601 @node Protocol
8602 @subsubsection Communication protocol
8603
8604 @cindex debugging stub, example
8605 @cindex remote stub, example
8606 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
8607 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8608 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8609 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8610 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8611 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8612 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8613 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8614
8615 However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8616 the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8617 target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8618 it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8619
8620 In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8621 transmitted and received data respectfully.
8622
8623 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8624 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8625 @cindex remote serial protocol
8626 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments)
8627 are sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the
8628 character @samp{$}, this is followed by an optional two-digit
8629 @var{sequence-id} and the character @samp{:}, the actual
8630 @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character @samp{#} followed by a
8631 two-digit @var{checksum}:
8632
8633 @example
8634 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8635 @end example
8636 @noindent
8637 or, with the optional @var{sequence-id}:
8638 @example
8639 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8640 @end example
8641
8642 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8643 @noindent
8644 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8645 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (that
8646 consisting of both the optional @var{sequence-id}@code{:} and the actual
8647 @var{packet-data}) (an eight bit unsigned checksum).
8648
8649 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8650 @noindent
8651 The two-digit @var{sequence-id}, when present, is returned with the
8652 acknowledgment. Beyond that its meaning is poorly defined.
8653 @value{GDBN} is not known to output @var{sequence-id}s.
8654
8655 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8656 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8657 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8658 retransmission):
8659
8660 @example
8661 <- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8662 -> @code{+}
8663 @end example
8664 @noindent
8665 If the received packet included a @var{sequence-id} than that is
8666 appended to a positive acknowledgment:
8667
8668 @example
8669 <- @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8670 -> @code{+}@var{sequence-id}
8671 @end example
8672
8673 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8674 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8675 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8676 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8677
8678 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8679 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for an
8680 exception). @samp{:} can not appear as the third character in a packet.
8681 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} and @samp{;}
8682 (unfortunately some packets chose to use @samp{:}). Except where
8683 otherwise noted all numbers are represented in HEX with leading zeros
8684 suppressed.
8685
8686 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
8687 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
8688 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8689 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
8690 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8691 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8692 value greater than 126 should not be used.
8693
8694 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8695 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8696 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
8697
8698 So:
8699 @example
8700 "@code{0* }"
8701 @end example
8702 @noindent
8703 means the same as "0000".
8704
8705 The error response, returned for some packets includes a two character
8706 error number. That number is not well defined.
8707
8708 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8709 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8710 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
8711 on that response.
8712
8713 Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8714 their corresponding response @var{data}:
8715
8716 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8717 @item Packet
8718 @tab Request
8719 @tab Description
8720
8721 @item extended ops @emph{(optional)}
8722 @tab @code{!}
8723 @tab
8724 Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
8725 The extended remote protocol support the @samp{R} packet.
8726 @item
8727 @tab reply @samp{}
8728 @tab
8729 Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8730 unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8731 support protocol extensions.
8732
8733 @item last signal
8734 @tab @code{?}
8735 @tab
8736 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8737 and continue.
8738 @item
8739 @tab reply
8740 @tab see below
8741
8742
8743 @item reserved
8744 @tab @code{a}
8745 @tab Reserved for future use
8746
8747 @item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8748 @tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8749 @tab
8750 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8751 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
8752 See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
8753 @item
8754 @tab reply @code{OK}
8755 @item
8756 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8757
8758 @item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8759 @tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8760 @tab
8761 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
8762 transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
8763 transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
8764 acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
8765 to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
8766 ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
8767 specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
8768 that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
8769 happened.}
8770
8771 @item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
8772 @tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
8773 @tab
8774 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
8775 breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
8776 @samp{z} packets.}
8777
8778 @item continue
8779 @tab @code{c}@var{addr}
8780 @tab
8781 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8782 current address.
8783 @item
8784 @tab reply
8785 @tab see below
8786
8787 @item continue with signal @emph{(optional)}
8788 @tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
8789 @tab
8790 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
8791 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
8792 @item
8793 @tab reply
8794 @tab see below
8795
8796 @item toggle debug @emph{(deprecated)}
8797 @tab @code{d}
8798 @tab
8799 toggle debug flag.
8800
8801 @item detach @emph{(optional)}
8802 @tab @code{D}
8803 @tab
8804 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
8805 @value{GDBN} disconnects.
8806 @item
8807 @tab reply @emph{no response}
8808 @tab
8809 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet
8810
8811 @item reserved
8812 @tab @code{e}
8813 @tab Reserved for future use
8814
8815 @item reserved
8816 @tab @code{E}
8817 @tab Reserved for future use
8818
8819 @item reserved
8820 @tab @code{f}
8821 @tab Reserved for future use
8822
8823 @item reserved
8824 @tab @code{F}
8825 @tab Reserved for future use
8826
8827 @item read registers
8828 @tab @code{g}
8829 @tab Read general registers.
8830 @item
8831 @tab reply @var{XX...}
8832 @tab
8833 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
8834 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
8835 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
8836 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
8837 @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8838 @code{g} packets is specified below.
8839 @item
8840 @tab @code{E}@var{NN}
8841 @tab for an error.
8842
8843 @item write regs
8844 @tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
8845 @tab
8846 See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
8847 @item
8848 @tab reply @code{OK}
8849 @tab for success
8850 @item
8851 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8852 @tab for an error
8853
8854 @item reserved
8855 @tab @code{h}
8856 @tab Reserved for future use
8857
8858 @item set thread @emph{(optional)}
8859 @tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
8860 @tab
8861 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
8862 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
8863 continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
8864 thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
8865 @item
8866 @tab reply @code{OK}
8867 @tab for success
8868 @item
8869 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8870 @tab for an error
8871
8872 @c FIXME: JTC:
8873 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
8874 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
8875 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
8876 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
8877 @c described. For example:
8878 @c
8879 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8880 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
8881 @c otherwise returns current registers.
8882 @c
8883 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8884 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
8885 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
8886
8887 @item cycle step @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
8888 @tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
8889 @tab
8890 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
8891 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
8892 step starting at that address.
8893
8894 @item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8895 @tab @code{I}
8896 @tab
8897 See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
8898
8899 @item reserved
8900 @tab @code{j}
8901 @tab Reserved for future use
8902
8903 @item reserved
8904 @tab @code{J}
8905 @tab Reserved for future use
8906
8907 @item kill request @emph{(optional)}
8908 @tab @code{k}
8909 @tab
8910 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
8911 thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
8912
8913 @item reserved
8914 @tab @code{l}
8915 @tab Reserved for future use
8916
8917 @item reserved
8918 @tab @code{L}
8919 @tab Reserved for future use
8920
8921 @item read memory
8922 @tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
8923 @tab
8924 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
8925 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
8926 using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8927 transfer mechanism is needed.}
8928 @item
8929 @tab reply @var{XX...}
8930 @tab
8931 @var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
8932 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
8933 sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
8934 @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
8935 @item
8936 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8937 @tab @var{NN} is errno
8938
8939 @item write mem
8940 @tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
8941 @tab
8942 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
8943 @var{XX...} is the data.
8944 @item
8945 @tab reply @code{OK}
8946 @tab for success
8947 @item
8948 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8949 @tab
8950 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
8951 written).
8952
8953 @item reserved
8954 @tab @code{n}
8955 @tab Reserved for future use
8956
8957 @item reserved
8958 @tab @code{N}
8959 @tab Reserved for future use
8960
8961 @item reserved
8962 @tab @code{o}
8963 @tab Reserved for future use
8964
8965 @item reserved
8966 @tab @code{O}
8967 @tab Reserved for future use
8968
8969 @item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
8970 @tab @code{p}@var{n...}
8971 @tab
8972 See write register.
8973 @item
8974 @tab return @var{r....}
8975 @tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
8976
8977 @item write reg @emph{(optional)}
8978 @tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
8979 @tab
8980 Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
8981 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
8982 @item
8983 @tab reply @code{OK}
8984 @tab for success
8985 @item
8986 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8987 @tab for an error
8988
8989 @item general query @emph{(optional)}
8990 @tab @code{q}@var{query}
8991 @tab
8992 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} @var{query}'s
8993 have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
8994 company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
8995 optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
8996 must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
8997 @item
8998 @tab reply @code{XX...}
8999 @tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
9000 @item
9001 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9002 @tab error reply
9003 @item
9004 @tab reply @samp{}
9005 @tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9006
9007 @item general set @emph{(optional)}
9008 @tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9009 @tab
9010 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9011 naming conventions.
9012
9013 @item reset @emph{(deprecated)}
9014 @tab @code{r}
9015 @tab
9016 Reset the entire system.
9017
9018 @item remote restart @emph{(optional)}
9019 @tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9020 @tab
9021 Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9022 definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9023 packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
9024
9025 @item step @emph{(optional)}
9026 @tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9027 @tab
9028 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9029 same address.
9030 @item
9031 @tab reply
9032 @tab see below
9033
9034 @item step with signal @emph{(optional)}
9035 @tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9036 @tab
9037 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9038 @item
9039 @tab reply
9040 @tab see below
9041
9042 @item search @emph{(optional)}
9043 @tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9044 @tab
9045 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9046 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
9047 bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
9048
9049 @item thread alive @emph{(optional)}
9050 @tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9051 @tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9052 @item
9053 @tab reply @code{OK}
9054 @tab thread is still alive
9055 @item
9056 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9057 @tab thread is dead
9058
9059 @item reserved
9060 @tab @code{u}
9061 @tab Reserved for future use
9062
9063 @item reserved
9064 @tab @code{U}
9065 @tab Reserved for future use
9066
9067 @item reserved
9068 @tab @code{v}
9069 @tab Reserved for future use
9070
9071 @item reserved
9072 @tab @code{V}
9073 @tab Reserved for future use
9074
9075 @item reserved
9076 @tab @code{w}
9077 @tab Reserved for future use
9078
9079 @item reserved
9080 @tab @code{W}
9081 @tab Reserved for future use
9082
9083 @item reserved
9084 @tab @code{x}
9085 @tab Reserved for future use
9086
9087 @item write mem (binary) @emph{(optional)}
9088 @tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9089 @tab
9090 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
9091 binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9092 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
9093 @item
9094 @tab reply @code{OK}
9095 @tab for success
9096 @item
9097 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9098 @tab for an error
9099
9100 @item reserved
9101 @tab @code{y}
9102 @tab Reserved for future use
9103
9104 @item reserved
9105 @tab @code{Y}
9106 @tab Reserved for future use
9107
9108 @item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9109 @tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9110 @tab
9111 See @samp{Z}.
9112
9113 @item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9114 @tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9115 @tab
9116 @var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9117 breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9118 @samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9119 bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9120 the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
9121 @var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9122 potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9123 implemented in an ident-potentent way.
9124 @item
9125 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9126 @tab for an error
9127 @item
9128 @tab reply @code{OK}
9129 @tab for success
9130 @item
9131 @tab @samp{}
9132 @tab If not supported.
9133
9134 @item reserved
9135 @tab <other>
9136 @tab Reserved for future use
9137
9138 @end multitable
9139
9140 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9141 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9142 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9143 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9144 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9145 conventions is used.
9146
9147 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9148
9149 @item @code{S}@var{AA}
9150 @tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9151
9152 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9153 @tab
9154 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9155 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9156 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9157 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
9158 starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
9159 @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9160 extend the protocol.
9161
9162 @item @code{W}@var{AA}
9163 @tab
9164 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9165 applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9166
9167 @item @code{X}@var{AA}
9168 @tab
9169 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9170
9171 @item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{tttttttt}@code{;}@var{dddddddd}@code{;}@var{bbbbbbbb} @strong{(obsolete)}
9172 @tab
9173 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{tttttttt} = address of symbol "_start";
9174 @var{dddddddd} = base of data section; @var{bbbbbbbb} = base of bss
9175 section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference
9176 between this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may
9177 arrive spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the
9178 host debugger.}
9179
9180 @item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9181 @tab
9182 @var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
9183 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9184 for 'W', 'T', etc.
9185
9186 @end multitable
9187
9188 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9189
9190 @multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9191
9192 @item current thread
9193 @tab @code{q}@code{C}
9194 @tab Return the current thread id.
9195 @item
9196 @tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9197 @tab
9198 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9199 @item
9200 @tab reply *
9201 @tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9202
9203 @item compute CRC of memory block
9204 @tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9205 @tab
9206 @item
9207 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9208 @tab An error (such as memory fault)
9209 @item
9210 @tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9211 @tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9212
9213 @item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9214 @tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9215 @tab
9216 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9217 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9218 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9219 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9220 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9221 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9222 @item
9223 @tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9224 @tab
9225 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9226 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9227 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9228 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9229 a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9230 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9231
9232 @item query sect offs
9233 @tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
9234 @tab
9235 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9236 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9237 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9238 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
9239 @item
9240 @tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9241
9242 @item thread info request
9243 @tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9244 @tab
9245 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9246 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9247 @item
9248 @tab reply *
9249 @tab
9250 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9251
9252 @item remote command
9253 @tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9254 @tab
9255 @var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9256 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9257 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9258 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9259 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9260 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9261 @item
9262 @tab reply @code{OK}
9263 @tab
9264 A command response with no output.
9265 @item
9266 @tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9267 @tab
9268 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9269 @item
9270 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9271 @tab
9272 Indicate a badly formed request.
9273
9274 @item
9275 @tab reply @samp{}
9276 @tab
9277 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9278
9279 @end multitable
9280
9281 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9282 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9283 bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9284 space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9285 The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9286 least-significant.
9287
9288 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9289
9290 @item MIPS32
9291 @tab
9292 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
9293 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9294 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9295
9296 @item MIPS64
9297 @tab
9298 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9299 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9300 as @code{MIPS32}.
9301
9302 @end multitable
9303
9304 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9305 does not get any direct output:
9306
9307 @example
9308 <- @code{R00}
9309 -> @code{+}
9310 @emph{target restarts}
9311 <- @code{?}
9312 -> @code{+}
9313 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9314 <- @code{+}
9315 @end example
9316
9317 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9318
9319 @example
9320 <- @code{G1445...}
9321 -> @code{+}
9322 <- @code{s}
9323 -> @code{+}
9324 @emph{time passes}
9325 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9326 <- @code{+}
9327 <- @code{g}
9328 -> @code{+}
9329 -> @code{1455...}
9330 <- @code{+}
9331 @end example
9332
9333 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
9334 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
9335 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
9336 @cindex serial connections, debugging
9337 If you have trouble with the serial connection, you can use the command
9338 @code{set remotedebug}. This makes @value{GDBN} report on all packets sent
9339 back and forth across the serial line to the remote machine. The
9340 packet-debugging information is printed on the @value{GDBN} standard output
9341 stream. @code{set remotedebug off} turns it off, and @code{show
9342 remotedebug} shows you its current state.
9343
9344 @node Server
9345 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9346
9347 @kindex gdbserver
9348 @cindex remote connection without stubs
9349 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9350 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9351 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9352
9353 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9354 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9355 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9356 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9357 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9358 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9359 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9360 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9361 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9362 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9363 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9364 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9365 choice for debugging.
9366
9367 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9368 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9369 protocol.
9370
9371 @table @emph
9372 @item On the target machine,
9373 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9374 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9375 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9376 system does all the symbol handling.
9377
9378 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9379 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9380 syntax is:
9381
9382 @smallexample
9383 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9384 @end smallexample
9385
9386 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9387 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9388 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9389 @file{/dev/com1}:
9390
9391 @smallexample
9392 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9393 @end smallexample
9394
9395 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9396 with it.
9397
9398 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9399
9400 @smallexample
9401 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9402 @end smallexample
9403
9404 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9405 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9406 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9407 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9408 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9409 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9410 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9411 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9412 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
9413 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
9414 @code{target remote} command.
9415
9416 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9417 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9418 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9419 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9420 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9421 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
9422 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9423 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9424 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9425 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9426
9427 @smallexample
9428 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9429 @end smallexample
9430
9431 @noindent
9432 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9433
9434 @smallexample
9435 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9436 @end smallexample
9437
9438 @noindent
9439 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9440 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9441 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9442 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9443 @samp{Connection refused}.
9444 @end table
9445
9446 @node NetWare
9447 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9448
9449 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
9450 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9451 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9452 @code{target remote}.
9453
9454 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9455 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9456
9457 @table @emph
9458 @item On the target machine,
9459 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9460 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9461 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9462 host system does all the symbol handling.
9463
9464 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9465 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9466 program. The syntax is:
9467
9468 @smallexample
9469 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9470 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9471 @end smallexample
9472
9473 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9474 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
9475 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
9476
9477 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9478 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
9479 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
9480
9481 @smallexample
9482 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9483 @end smallexample
9484
9485 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9486 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9487 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9488 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9489 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9490 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
9491 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9492 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9493 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9494
9495 @smallexample
9496 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9497 @end smallexample
9498
9499 @noindent
9500 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9501 @end table
9502
9503 @node KOD
9504 @section Kernel Object Display
9505
9506 @cindex kernel object display
9507 @cindex kernel object
9508 @cindex KOD
9509
9510 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9511 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9512 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9513 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9514 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9515
9516 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9517 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9518
9519 @example
9520 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
9521 @end example
9522
9523 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9524 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9525 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9526 after the operating system:
9527
9528 @example
9529 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
9530 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9531 Object Description
9532 any Any and all objects
9533 @end example
9534
9535 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9536 by the kernel.
9537
9538 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9539 is supported other than to try it.
9540
9541
9542 @node Configurations
9543 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9544
9545 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9546 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9547 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9548
9549 There are three major categories of configurations: native
9550 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9551 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9552 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9553 are quite different from each other.
9554
9555 @menu
9556 * Native::
9557 * Embedded OS::
9558 * Embedded Processors::
9559 * Architectures::
9560 @end menu
9561
9562 @node Native
9563 @section Native
9564
9565 This section describes details specific to particular native
9566 configurations.
9567
9568 @menu
9569 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
9570 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9571 @end menu
9572
9573 @node HP-UX
9574 @subsection HP-UX
9575
9576 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9577 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9578 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9579
9580 @node SVR4 Process Information
9581 @subsection SVR4 process information
9582
9583 @kindex /proc
9584 @cindex process image
9585
9586 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9587 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9588 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9589 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9590 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9591 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9592 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9593 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9594
9595 @table @code
9596 @kindex info proc
9597 @item info proc
9598 Summarize available information about the process.
9599
9600 @kindex info proc mappings
9601 @item info proc mappings
9602 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9603 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9604
9605 @kindex info proc times
9606 @item info proc times
9607 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9608 its children.
9609
9610 @kindex info proc id
9611 @item info proc id
9612 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9613 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9614
9615 @kindex info proc status
9616 @item info proc status
9617 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9618 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9619 received.
9620
9621 @item info proc all
9622 Show all the above information about the process.
9623 @end table
9624
9625 @node Embedded OS
9626 @section Embedded Operating Systems
9627
9628 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9629 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9630 architectures.
9631
9632 @menu
9633 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9634 @end menu
9635
9636 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9637 various real-time operating systems.
9638
9639 @node VxWorks
9640 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9641
9642 @cindex VxWorks
9643
9644 @table @code
9645
9646 @kindex target vxworks
9647 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9648 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9649 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9650
9651 @end table
9652
9653 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9654 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9655
9656 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9657 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9658 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9659 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
9660 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
9661 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
9662 @value{GDB} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
9663
9664 @table @code
9665 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9666 @kindex vxworks-timeout
9667 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9668 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9669 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9670 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9671 of a thin network line.
9672 @end table
9673
9674 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9675 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9676 procedures.
9677
9678 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9679 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9680 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9681 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9682 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9683 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9684 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9685 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9686 manual.
9687 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9688
9689 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9690 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
9691 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or @code{vxgdb},
9692 depending on your installation).
9693
9694 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9695
9696 @example
9697 (vxgdb)
9698 @end example
9699
9700 @menu
9701 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
9702 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
9703 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
9704 @end menu
9705
9706 @node VxWorks Connection
9707 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
9708
9709 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
9710 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
9711
9712 @example
9713 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
9714 @end example
9715
9716 @need 750
9717 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
9718
9719 @smallexample
9720 Attaching remote machine across net...
9721 Connected to tt.
9722 @end smallexample
9723
9724 @need 1000
9725 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
9726 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
9727 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
9728 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
9729 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
9730
9731 @example
9732 prog.o: No such file or directory.
9733 @end example
9734
9735 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
9736 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
9737 command again.
9738
9739 @node VxWorks Download
9740 @subsubsection VxWorks download
9741
9742 @cindex download to VxWorks
9743 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
9744 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
9745 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
9746 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
9747 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
9748 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
9749 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
9750 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
9751 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
9752 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
9753 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
9754 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
9755 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
9756 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
9757 program, type this on VxWorks:
9758
9759 @example
9760 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
9761 @end example
9762
9763 @noindent
9764 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
9765
9766 @example
9767 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
9768 (vxgdb) load prog.o
9769 @end example
9770
9771 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
9772
9773 @smallexample
9774 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
9775 @end smallexample
9776
9777 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
9778 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
9779 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
9780 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
9781 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
9782 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
9783 table.)
9784
9785 @node VxWorks Attach
9786 @subsubsection Running tasks
9787
9788 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
9789 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
9790 follows:
9791
9792 @example
9793 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
9794 @end example
9795
9796 @noindent
9797 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
9798 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
9799 the time of attachment.
9800
9801 @node Embedded Processors
9802 @section Embedded Processors
9803
9804 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
9805 configurations.
9806
9807 @menu
9808 * A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
9809 * ARM:: ARM
9810 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
9811 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
9812 * i960:: Intel i960
9813 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
9814 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
9815 * M88K:: Motorola M88K
9816 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
9817 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
9818 * PowerPC: PowerPC
9819 * SH:: Hitachi SH
9820 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
9821 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
9822 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
9823 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
9824 @end menu
9825
9826 @node A29K Embedded
9827 @subsection AMD A29K Embedded
9828
9829 @menu
9830 * A29K UDI::
9831 * A29K EB29K::
9832 * Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
9833 * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
9834 * Remote Log:: Remote log
9835 @end menu
9836
9837 @table @code
9838
9839 @kindex target adapt
9840 @item target adapt @var{dev}
9841 Adapt monitor for A29K.
9842
9843 @kindex target amd-eb
9844 @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
9845 @cindex AMD EB29K
9846 Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
9847 @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
9848 @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
9849 name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
9850 @xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
9851
9852 @end table
9853
9854 @node A29K UDI
9855 @subsubsection A29K UDI
9856
9857 @cindex UDI
9858 @cindex AMD29K via UDI
9859
9860 @value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
9861 protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
9862 configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
9863 program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
9864 use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
9865 @code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
9866
9867 @table @code
9868 @item target udi @var{keyword}
9869 @kindex udi
9870 Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
9871 @var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
9872 This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
9873 connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
9874 working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
9875 to its pathname.
9876 @end table
9877
9878 @node A29K EB29K
9879 @subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
9880
9881 @cindex EB29K board
9882 @cindex running 29K programs
9883
9884 AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
9885 with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
9886 term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
9887 @value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
9888 must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
9889 board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
9890 assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
9891 @file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
9892
9893 @node Comms (EB29K)
9894 @subsubsection Communications setup
9895
9896 The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
9897 in DOS on the PC:
9898
9899 @example
9900 C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
9901 @end example
9902
9903 @noindent
9904 This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
9905 bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
9906 you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
9907 end of the connection as well.
9908 @c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
9909 @c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
9910 @c
9911 @c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
9912 @c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
9913 @c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
9914 @c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
9915 @c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
9916
9917 To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
9918 the following at the DOS console:
9919
9920 @example
9921 C:\> CTTY com1
9922 @end example
9923
9924 @noindent
9925 (Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
9926 the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
9927 had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line).
9928
9929 From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
9930 @code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
9931
9932 @example
9933 cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
9934 @end example
9935
9936 @noindent
9937 The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
9938 serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
9939 may look something like the following:
9940
9941 @example
9942 tip -9600 /dev/ttya
9943 @end example
9944
9945 @noindent
9946 Your system may require a different name where we show
9947 @file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
9948 parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
9949 @code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
9950 system table @file{/etc/remote}.
9951 @c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
9952 @c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
9953 @c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
9954 @c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
9955 @c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
9956 @c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
9957 @c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
9958 @c
9959 @c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
9960 @c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
9961 @c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
9962
9963 @kindex EBMON
9964 Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
9965 directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
9966 start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
9967 with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
9968 @code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
9969 @code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
9970
9971 @example
9972 C:\> G:
9973
9974 G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
9975
9976 G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
9977 Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
9978 Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
9979 Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
9980
9981 Enter '?' or 'H' for help
9982
9983 PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
9984 I/O Base = 0x208
9985 Memory Base = 0xd0000
9986
9987 Data Memory Size = 2048KB
9988 Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
9989 Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
9990
9991 PageSize = 0x400
9992 Register Stack Size = 0x800
9993 Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
9994
9995 CPU PRL = 0x3
9996 Am29027 Available = No
9997 Byte Write Available = Yes
9998
9999 # ~.
10000 @end example
10001
10002 Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10003 typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10004 running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10005
10006 For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10007 way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
10008 system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
10009 PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10010 something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10011 other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10012 from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10013 serial line.
10014
10015 @node gdb-EB29K
10016 @subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10017
10018 Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10019 program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10020 name of your 29K program:
10021
10022 @example
10023 cd /usr/joe/work29k
10024 @value{GDBP} myfoo
10025 @end example
10026
10027 @need 500
10028 Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10029
10030 @example
10031 target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10032 @c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10033 @c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10034 @c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10035 @end example
10036
10037 @noindent
10038 In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10039 @file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10040 @code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10041 In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10042 a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10043 the name on the Unix side.
10044
10045 At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10046 to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10047 @code{run}.
10048
10049 To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10050 command.
10051
10052 To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10053 once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10054 @code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10055 @code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
10056 Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
10057 and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10058
10059 @node Remote Log
10060 @subsubsection Remote log
10061 @kindex eb.log
10062 @cindex log file for EB29K
10063
10064 The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10065 current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10066 @file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10067 of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10068 another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10069 unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10070
10071 @node ARM
10072 @subsection ARM
10073
10074 @table @code
10075
10076 @kindex target rdi
10077 @item target rdi @var{dev}
10078 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10079 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10080 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10081
10082 @kindex target rdp
10083 @item target rdp @var{dev}
10084 ARM Demon monitor.
10085
10086 @end table
10087
10088 @node H8/300
10089 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
10090
10091 @table @code
10092
10093 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
10094 @item target hms @var{dev}
10095 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10096 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10097 line and the communications speed used.
10098
10099 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
10100 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
10101 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10102
10103 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10104 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
10105 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
10106 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
10107 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10108
10109 @end table
10110
10111 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10112 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10113 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
10114 @cindex Hitachi SH download
10115 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10116 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10117 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10118 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10119
10120 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10121 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10122
10123 @enumerate
10124 @item
10125 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10126 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10127 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
10128 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
10129 H8/300, or H8/500.)
10130
10131 @item
10132 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10133 serial device available on your host is the default).
10134
10135 @item
10136 what speed to use over the serial device.
10137 @end enumerate
10138
10139 @menu
10140 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10141 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10142 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10143 @end menu
10144
10145 @node Hitachi Boards
10146 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10147
10148 @c only for Unix hosts
10149 @kindex device
10150 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
10151 Use the special @code{@value{GDBP}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
10152 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10153 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10154 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10155
10156 @kindex speed
10157 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
10158 @code{@value{GDBP}} has another special command to set the communications
10159 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
10160 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
10161 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10162 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
10163
10164 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10165 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10166 use a DOS host,
10167 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10168 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10169 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10170 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10171
10172 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10173 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10174 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10175 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10176
10177 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10178 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10179 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10180 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
10181 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
10182 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10183 @code{COM2}.
10184
10185 @example
10186 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10187 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10188
10189 Resident portion of MODE loaded
10190
10191 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10192
10193 @end example
10194
10195 @quotation
10196 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10197 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10198 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10199 your development board.
10200 @end quotation
10201
10202 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
10203 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10204 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
10205 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBP}} prompts
10206 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10207 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10208 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10209 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10210 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10211 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10212 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10213 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10214 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10215
10216 @smallexample
10217 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
10218 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
10219 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10220 the conditions.
10221 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
10222 for details.
10223 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10224 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
10225 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
10226 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
10227 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10228 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10229 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10230 @end smallexample
10231
10232 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10233 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10234 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10235 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10236 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10237 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10238
10239 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10240 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10241 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10242
10243 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10244 @itemize @bullet
10245 @item
10246 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10247 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10248
10249 @item
10250 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10251 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10252 to detect program completion.
10253 @end itemize
10254
10255 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10256 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10257
10258 @node Hitachi ICE
10259 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10260
10261 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
10262 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10263 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10264 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10265
10266 @table @code
10267 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10268 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10269 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10270 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10271 (for example, @samp{9600}).
10272
10273 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10274 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10275 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10276 @end table
10277
10278 @node Hitachi Special
10279 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10280
10281 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10282
10283 @table @code
10284
10285 @kindex set machine
10286 @kindex show machine
10287 @item set machine h8300
10288 @itemx set machine h8300h
10289 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10290 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10291 to check which variant is currently in effect.
10292
10293 @end table
10294
10295 @node H8/500
10296 @subsection H8/500
10297
10298 @table @code
10299
10300 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
10301 @cindex memory models, H8/500
10302 @item set memory @var{mod}
10303 @itemx show memory
10304 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10305 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10306 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10307 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10308
10309 @end table
10310
10311 @node i960
10312 @subsection Intel i960
10313
10314 @table @code
10315
10316 @kindex target mon960
10317 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
10318 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10319
10320 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
10321 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10322 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10323 @file{/dev/ttya}.
10324
10325 @end table
10326
10327 @cindex Nindy
10328 @cindex i960
10329 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10330 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10331 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10332
10333 @itemize @bullet
10334 @item
10335 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10336 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10337
10338 @item
10339 By responding to a prompt on startup;
10340
10341 @item
10342 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10343 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10344
10345 @kindex target nindy
10346 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
10347 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10348 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10349 @file{/dev/ttya}.
10350
10351 @end itemize
10352
10353 @cindex download to Nindy-960
10354 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10355 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10356 @value{GDBN}.
10357
10358 @menu
10359 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10360 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10361 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10362 @end menu
10363
10364 @node Nindy Startup
10365 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10366
10367 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10368 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10369 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10370
10371 @example
10372 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10373 @end example
10374
10375 @noindent
10376 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10377 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10378 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10379 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10380 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10381
10382 @node Nindy Options
10383 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
10384
10385 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10386 Nindy-960 board attached:
10387
10388 @table @code
10389 @item -r @var{port}
10390 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10391 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10392 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10393 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10394 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10395 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10396
10397 @item -O
10398 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10399 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10400 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10401 target architecture.
10402
10403 @quotation
10404 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10405 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10406 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10407 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10408 this process with an interrupt.
10409 @end quotation
10410
10411 @item -brk
10412 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10413 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10414
10415 @quotation
10416 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10417 requires; it only works with a few boards.
10418 @end quotation
10419 @end table
10420
10421 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10422 port.
10423
10424 @c @group
10425 @node Nindy Reset
10426 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
10427
10428 @table @code
10429 @item reset
10430 @kindex reset
10431 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10432 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10433 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10434 a break is detected.
10435 @end table
10436 @c @end group
10437
10438 @node M32R/D
10439 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10440
10441 @table @code
10442
10443 @kindex target m32r
10444 @item target m32r @var{dev}
10445 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10446
10447 @end table
10448
10449 @node M68K
10450 @subsection M68k
10451
10452 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10453 target command for the following ROM monitors.
10454
10455 @table @code
10456
10457 @kindex target abug
10458 @item target abug @var{dev}
10459 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10460
10461 @kindex target cpu32bug
10462 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10463 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10464
10465 @kindex target dbug
10466 @item target dbug @var{dev}
10467 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10468
10469 @kindex target est
10470 @item target est @var{dev}
10471 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10472
10473 @kindex target rom68k
10474 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
10475 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10476
10477 @end table
10478
10479 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10480 instead have only a single special target command:
10481
10482 @table @code
10483
10484 @kindex target es1800
10485 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
10486 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10487
10488 @end table
10489
10490 [context?]
10491
10492 @table @code
10493
10494 @kindex target rombug
10495 @item target rombug @var{dev}
10496 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10497
10498 @end table
10499
10500 @node M88K
10501 @subsection M88K
10502
10503 @table @code
10504
10505 @kindex target bug
10506 @item target bug @var{dev}
10507 BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10508
10509 @end table
10510
10511 @node MIPS Embedded
10512 @subsection MIPS Embedded
10513
10514 @cindex MIPS boards
10515 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10516 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10517 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10518
10519 @need 1000
10520 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10521
10522 @table @code
10523 @item target mips @var{port}
10524 @kindex target mips @var{port}
10525 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10526 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10527 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10528 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10529 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10530 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10531
10532 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10533 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10534 debugger:
10535
10536 @example
10537 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
10538 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10539 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10540 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10541 (@value{GDBP}) run
10542 @end example
10543
10544 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10545 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10546 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10547 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10548 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10549
10550 @item target pmon @var{port}
10551 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
10552 PMON ROM monitor.
10553
10554 @item target ddb @var{port}
10555 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
10556 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10557
10558 @item target lsi @var{port}
10559 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
10560 LSI variant of PMON.
10561
10562 @kindex target r3900
10563 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
10564 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10565
10566 @kindex target array
10567 @item target array @var{dev}
10568 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10569
10570 @end table
10571
10572
10573 @noindent
10574 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10575
10576 @table @code
10577 @item set processor @var{args}
10578 @itemx show processor
10579 @kindex set processor @var{args}
10580 @kindex show processor
10581 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10582 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10583 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10584 to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10585 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10586 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10587 @value{GDBN} is using.
10588
10589 @item set mipsfpu double
10590 @itemx set mipsfpu single
10591 @itemx set mipsfpu none
10592 @itemx show mipsfpu
10593 @kindex set mipsfpu
10594 @kindex show mipsfpu
10595 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
10596 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10597 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10598 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
10599 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBINIT}
10600 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10601 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10602 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10603 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10604 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10605 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10606 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10607 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10608
10609 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10610 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10611 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10612
10613 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10614 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
10615
10616 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
10617 @itemx show remotedebug
10618 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10619 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10620 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10621 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10622 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10623 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10624 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10625 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10626 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10627 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10628 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10629
10630 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
10631 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10632 @itemx show timeout
10633 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
10634 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10635 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10636 @kindex set timeout
10637 @kindex show timeout
10638 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
10639 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
10640 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10641 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10642 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10643 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10644 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10645 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10646 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10647 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10648
10649 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10650 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10651 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10652 to run before stopping.
10653 @end table
10654
10655 @node PowerPC
10656 @subsection PowerPC
10657
10658 @table @code
10659
10660 @kindex target dink32
10661 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
10662 DINK32 ROM monitor.
10663
10664 @kindex target ppcbug
10665 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10666 @kindex target ppcbug1
10667 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10668 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10669
10670 @kindex target sds
10671 @item target sds @var{dev}
10672 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10673
10674 @end table
10675
10676 @node PA
10677 @subsection HP PA Embedded
10678
10679 @table @code
10680
10681 @kindex target op50n
10682 @item target op50n @var{dev}
10683 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10684
10685 @kindex target w89k
10686 @item target w89k @var{dev}
10687 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10688
10689 @end table
10690
10691 @node SH
10692 @subsection Hitachi SH
10693
10694 @table @code
10695
10696 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
10697 @item target hms @var{dev}
10698 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
10699 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10700 the communications speed used.
10701
10702 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
10703 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
10704 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10705
10706 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
10707 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
10708 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
10709 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
10710 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10711
10712 @end table
10713
10714 @node Sparclet
10715 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
10716
10717 @cindex Sparclet
10718
10719 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
10720 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
10721 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10722 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
10723 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
10724
10725 @table @code
10726 @item timeout @var{args}
10727 @kindex remotetimeout
10728 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
10729 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10730 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
10731 @end table
10732
10733 @kindex Compiling
10734 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
10735 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
10736 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
10737 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
10738
10739 @example
10740 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
10741 @end example
10742
10743 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
10744
10745 @example
10746 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
10747 @end example
10748
10749 @kindex Running
10750 Once you have set
10751 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10752 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
10753 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
10754
10755 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10756
10757 @example
10758 (gdbslet)
10759 @end example
10760
10761 @menu
10762 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
10763 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
10764 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
10765 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
10766 @end menu
10767
10768 @node Sparclet File
10769 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
10770
10771 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
10772
10773 @example
10774 (gdbslet) file prog
10775 @end example
10776
10777 @need 1000
10778 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
10779 @value{GDBN} locates
10780 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
10781 path.
10782 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
10783 files will be searched as well.
10784 @value{GDBN} locates
10785 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
10786 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
10787 If it fails
10788 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
10789
10790 @example
10791 prog: No such file or directory.
10792 @end example
10793
10794 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
10795 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
10796 @code{target} command again.
10797
10798 @node Sparclet Connection
10799 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
10800
10801 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
10802 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
10803
10804 @example
10805 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
10806 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
10807 main () at ../prog.c:3
10808 @end example
10809
10810 @need 750
10811 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10812
10813 @example
10814 Connected to ttya.
10815 @end example
10816
10817 @node Sparclet Download
10818 @subsubsection Sparclet download
10819
10820 @cindex download to Sparclet
10821 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
10822 you can use the @value{GDBN}
10823 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
10824 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
10825 command.
10826 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
10827 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
10828 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
10829 of each of the file's sections.
10830 For instance, if the program
10831 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
10832 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10833
10834 @example
10835 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
10836 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
10837 @end example
10838
10839 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
10840 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
10841 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
10842
10843 @node Sparclet Execution
10844 @subsubsection Running and debugging
10845
10846 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
10847 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
10848 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
10849 manual for the list of commands.
10850
10851 @example
10852 (gdbslet) b main
10853 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
10854 (gdbslet) run
10855 Starting program: prog
10856 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
10857 3 char *symarg = 0;
10858 (gdbslet) step
10859 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
10860 (gdbslet)
10861 @end example
10862
10863 @node Sparclite
10864 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
10865
10866 @table @code
10867
10868 @kindex target sparclite
10869 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
10870 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
10871 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
10872 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
10873 remote protocol.
10874
10875 @end table
10876
10877 @node ST2000
10878 @subsection Tandem ST2000
10879
10880 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
10881 STDBUG protocol.
10882
10883 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
10884 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
10885
10886 @example
10887 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
10888 @end example
10889
10890 @noindent
10891 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
10892 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
10893 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
10894 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
10895 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10896
10897 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
10898 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
10899 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
10900 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
10901 available on your host computer.
10902 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
10903 @c basically hearsay.
10904
10905 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
10906 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
10907 environment:
10908
10909 @table @code
10910 @item st2000 @var{command}
10911 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
10912 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
10913 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
10914 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
10915 manual for available commands.
10916
10917 @item connect
10918 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
10919 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
10920 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
10921 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
10922 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
10923 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
10924 @end table
10925
10926 @node Z8000
10927 @subsection Zilog Z8000
10928
10929 @cindex Z8000
10930 @cindex simulator, Z8000
10931 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
10932
10933 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
10934 a Z8000 simulator.
10935
10936 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
10937 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
10938 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
10939 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
10940
10941 @table @code
10942 @item target sim @var{args}
10943 @kindex sim
10944 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
10945 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
10946 options, specify them via @var{args}.
10947 @end table
10948
10949 @noindent
10950 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
10951 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
10952 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
10953 to run your program, and so on.
10954
10955 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
10956 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
10957 additional items of information as specially named registers:
10958
10959 @table @code
10960
10961 @item cycles
10962 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
10963
10964 @item insts
10965 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
10966
10967 @item time
10968 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
10969
10970 @end table
10971
10972 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
10973 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
10974 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
10975 simulated clock ticks.
10976
10977 @node Architectures
10978 @section Architectures
10979
10980 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
10981 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
10982
10983 @menu
10984 * A29K::
10985 * Alpha::
10986 * MIPS::
10987 @end menu
10988
10989 @node A29K
10990 @subsection A29K
10991
10992 @table @code
10993
10994 @kindex set rstack_high_address
10995 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
10996 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
10997 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
10998 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
10999 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
11000 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11001 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11002 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11003 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11004 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11005 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11006 hexadecimal.
11007
11008 @kindex show rstack_high_address
11009 @item show rstack_high_address
11010 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11011 processors.
11012
11013 @end table
11014
11015 @node Alpha
11016 @subsection Alpha
11017
11018 See the following section.
11019
11020 @node MIPS
11021 @subsection MIPS
11022
11023 @cindex stack on Alpha
11024 @cindex stack on MIPS
11025 @cindex Alpha stack
11026 @cindex MIPS stack
11027 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11028 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11029 find the beginning of a function.
11030
11031 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11032 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11033 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11034 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11035 commands:
11036
11037 @table @code
11038 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha,MIPS)
11039 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11040 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11041 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11042 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11043 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11044 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11045
11046 @item show heuristic-fence-post
11047 Display the current limit.
11048 @end table
11049
11050 @noindent
11051 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11052 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11053
11054
11055 @node Controlling GDB
11056 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11057
11058 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11059 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
11060 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
11061 described here.
11062
11063 @menu
11064 * Prompt:: Prompt
11065 * Editing:: Command editing
11066 * History:: Command history
11067 * Screen Size:: Screen size
11068 * Numbers:: Numbers
11069 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
11070 @end menu
11071
11072 @node Prompt
11073 @section Prompt
11074
11075 @cindex prompt
11076
11077 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11078 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11079 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11080 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11081 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11082 which one you are talking to.
11083
11084 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
11085 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11086 or a prompt that does not.
11087
11088 @table @code
11089 @kindex set prompt
11090 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11091 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11092
11093 @kindex show prompt
11094 @item show prompt
11095 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11096 @end table
11097
11098 @node Editing
11099 @section Command editing
11100 @cindex readline
11101 @cindex command line editing
11102
11103 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11104 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11105 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11106 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11107 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11108 debugging sessions.
11109
11110 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11111 command @code{set}.
11112
11113 @table @code
11114 @kindex set editing
11115 @cindex editing
11116 @item set editing
11117 @itemx set editing on
11118 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11119
11120 @item set editing off
11121 Disable command line editing.
11122
11123 @kindex show editing
11124 @item show editing
11125 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11126 @end table
11127
11128 @node History
11129 @section Command history
11130
11131 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11132 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11133 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11134 history facility.
11135
11136 @table @code
11137 @cindex history substitution
11138 @cindex history file
11139 @kindex set history filename
11140 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
11141 @item set history filename @var{fname}
11142 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11143 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11144 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11145 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11146 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11147 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
11148 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11149 is not set.
11150
11151 @cindex history save
11152 @kindex set history save
11153 @item set history save
11154 @itemx set history save on
11155 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11156 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11157
11158 @item set history save off
11159 Stop recording command history in a file.
11160
11161 @cindex history size
11162 @kindex set history size
11163 @item set history size @var{size}
11164 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11165 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11166 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11167 @end table
11168
11169 @cindex history expansion
11170 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11171 @ifset have-readline-appendices
11172 @xref{Event Designators}.
11173 @end ifset
11174
11175 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11176 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11177 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11178 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11179 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11180 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11181 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11182
11183 The commands to control history expansion are:
11184
11185 @table @code
11186 @kindex set history expansion
11187 @item set history expansion on
11188 @itemx set history expansion
11189 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11190
11191 @item set history expansion off
11192 Disable history expansion.
11193
11194 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11195 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11196 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11197 @ifset have-readline-appendices
11198 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
11199 @end ifset
11200
11201 @c @group
11202 @kindex show history
11203 @item show history
11204 @itemx show history filename
11205 @itemx show history save
11206 @itemx show history size
11207 @itemx show history expansion
11208 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11209 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11210 @c @end group
11211 @end table
11212
11213 @table @code
11214 @kindex show commands
11215 @item show commands
11216 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11217
11218 @item show commands @var{n}
11219 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11220
11221 @item show commands +
11222 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11223 @end table
11224
11225 @node Screen Size
11226 @section Screen size
11227 @cindex size of screen
11228 @cindex pauses in output
11229
11230 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11231 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11232 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11233 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11234 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11235 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11236 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11237 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11238
11239 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11240 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
11241 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
11242 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
11243 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11244 width} commands:
11245
11246 @table @code
11247 @kindex set height
11248 @kindex set width
11249 @kindex show width
11250 @kindex show height
11251 @item set height @var{lpp}
11252 @itemx show height
11253 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
11254 @itemx show width
11255 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11256 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11257 commands display the current settings.
11258
11259 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11260 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11261 file or to an editor buffer.
11262
11263 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11264 from wrapping its output.
11265 @end table
11266
11267 @node Numbers
11268 @section Numbers
11269 @cindex number representation
11270 @cindex entering numbers
11271
11272 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11273 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11274 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11275 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11276 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11277 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11278 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11279 radix} command.
11280
11281 @table @code
11282 @kindex set input-radix
11283 @item set input-radix @var{base}
11284 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11285 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11286 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11287 example, any of
11288
11289 @smallexample
11290 set radix 012
11291 set radix 10.
11292 set radix 0xa
11293 @end smallexample
11294
11295 @noindent
11296 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11297 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11298
11299 @kindex set output-radix
11300 @item set output-radix @var{base}
11301 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11302 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11303 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11304
11305 @kindex show input-radix
11306 @item show input-radix
11307 Display the current default base for numeric input.
11308
11309 @kindex show output-radix
11310 @item show output-radix
11311 Display the current default base for numeric display.
11312 @end table
11313
11314 @node Messages/Warnings
11315 @section Optional warnings and messages
11316
11317 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11318 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11319 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11320 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
11321
11322 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11323 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11324 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11325
11326 @table @code
11327 @kindex set verbose
11328 @item set verbose on
11329 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11330
11331 @item set verbose off
11332 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11333
11334 @kindex show verbose
11335 @item show verbose
11336 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11337 @end table
11338
11339 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11340 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11341 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11342 symbol files}).
11343
11344 @table @code
11345
11346 @kindex set complaints
11347 @item set complaints @var{limit}
11348 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11349 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11350 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11351 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
11352
11353 @kindex show complaints
11354 @item show complaints
11355 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
11356
11357 @end table
11358
11359 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11360 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11361 you try to run a program which is already running:
11362
11363 @example
11364 (@value{GDBP}) run
11365 The program being debugged has been started already.
11366 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11367 @end example
11368
11369 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11370 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11371
11372 @table @code
11373
11374 @kindex set confirm
11375 @cindex flinching
11376 @cindex confirmation
11377 @cindex stupid questions
11378 @item set confirm off
11379 Disables confirmation requests.
11380
11381 @item set confirm on
11382 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11383
11384 @kindex show confirm
11385 @item show confirm
11386 Displays state of confirmation requests.
11387
11388 @end table
11389
11390 @node Sequences
11391 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11392
11393 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
11394 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11395 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11396 files.
11397
11398 @menu
11399 * Define:: User-defined commands
11400 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11401 * Command Files:: Command files
11402 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
11403 @end menu
11404
11405 @node Define
11406 @section User-defined commands
11407
11408 @cindex user-defined command
11409 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11410 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11411 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11412 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11413 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
11414
11415 @smallexample
11416 define adder
11417 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11418 @end smallexample
11419
11420 @noindent
11421 To execute the command use:
11422
11423 @smallexample
11424 adder 1 2 3
11425 @end smallexample
11426
11427 @noindent
11428 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
11429 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11430 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11431 functions calls.
11432
11433 @table @code
11434
11435 @kindex define
11436 @item define @var{commandname}
11437 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11438 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11439
11440 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11441 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11442 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11443
11444 @kindex if
11445 @kindex else
11446 @item if
11447 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11448 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11449 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11450 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11451 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11452 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11453
11454 @kindex while
11455 @item while
11456 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11457 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11458 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11459 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11460 evaluates to true.
11461
11462 @kindex document
11463 @item document @var{commandname}
11464 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11465 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11466 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11467 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11468 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11469 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11470
11471 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11472 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11473 does not change the documentation.
11474
11475 @kindex help user-defined
11476 @item help user-defined
11477 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11478 (if any) for each.
11479
11480 @kindex show user
11481 @item show user
11482 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
11483 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11484 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
11485 definitions for all user-defined commands.
11486
11487 @end table
11488
11489 When user-defined commands are executed, the
11490 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11491 stops execution of the user-defined command.
11492
11493 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11494 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11495 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11496 messages when used in a user-defined command.
11497
11498 @node Hooks
11499 @section User-defined command hooks
11500 @cindex command hooks
11501 @cindex hooks, for commands
11502
11503 You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11504 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11505 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11506 before that command.
11507
11508 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
11509 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11510 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11511 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11512 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11513
11514 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11515 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11516 you could define:
11517
11518 @example
11519 define hook-stop
11520 handle SIGALRM nopass
11521 end
11522
11523 define hook-run
11524 handle SIGALRM pass
11525 end
11526
11527 define hook-continue
11528 handle SIGLARM pass
11529 end
11530 @end example
11531
11532 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11533 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11534 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11535 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11536 @c or not?
11537 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11538 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11539 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11540
11541 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11542 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11543
11544 @node Command Files
11545 @section Command files
11546
11547 @cindex command files
11548 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11549 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11550 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11551 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11552
11553 @cindex init file
11554 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
11555 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
11556 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11557 @dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix, or
11558 @file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. @value{GDBN} reads the init file (if
11559 any) in your home directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home
11560 directory is the one pointed to by the @code{HOME} environment
11561 variable.}, then processes command line options and operands, and then
11562 reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory. This is
11563 so the init file in your home directory can set options (such as
11564 @code{set complaints}) which affect the processing of the command line
11565 options and operands. The init files are not executed if you use the
11566 @samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}.
11567
11568 @cindex init file name
11569 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11570 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11571 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11572 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
11573 environments with special init file names:
11574
11575 @kindex .vxgdbinit
11576 @itemize @bullet
11577 @item
11578 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @samp{.vxgdbinit}
11579
11580 @kindex .os68gdbinit
11581 @item
11582 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @samp{.os68gdbinit}
11583
11584 @kindex .esgdbinit
11585 @item
11586 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @samp{.esgdbinit}
11587 @end itemize
11588
11589 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11590 @code{source} command:
11591
11592 @table @code
11593 @kindex source
11594 @item source @var{filename}
11595 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11596 @end table
11597
11598 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
11599 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
11600 of the command file.
11601
11602 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11603 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11604 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11605 when called from command files.
11606
11607 @node Output
11608 @section Commands for controlled output
11609
11610 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11611 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11612 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
11613 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11614 want.
11615
11616 @table @code
11617 @kindex echo
11618 @item echo @var{text}
11619 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11620 @c because it is not in ANSI.
11621 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
11622 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11623 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11624 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11625 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
11626 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
11627 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
11628 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
11629 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
11630
11631 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
11632 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
11633
11634 @example
11635 echo This is some text\n\
11636 which is continued\n\
11637 onto several lines.\n
11638 @end example
11639
11640 produces the same output as
11641
11642 @example
11643 echo This is some text\n
11644 echo which is continued\n
11645 echo onto several lines.\n
11646 @end example
11647
11648 @kindex output
11649 @item output @var{expression}
11650 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
11651 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
11652 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
11653 on expressions.
11654
11655 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
11656 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
11657 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
11658 formats}, for more information.
11659
11660 @kindex printf
11661 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
11662 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
11663 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
11664 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
11665 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
11666 subroutine
11667 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
11668 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
11669 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
11670 @c supported.
11671
11672 @example
11673 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
11674 @end example
11675
11676 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
11677
11678 @smallexample
11679 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
11680 @end smallexample
11681
11682 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
11683 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
11684 letter.
11685 @end table
11686
11687 @node Emacs
11688 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
11689
11690 @cindex Emacs
11691 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
11692 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
11693 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
11694 @value{GDBN}.
11695
11696 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
11697 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
11698 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
11699 created Emacs buffer.
11700 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
11701
11702 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
11703 things:
11704
11705 @itemize @bullet
11706 @item
11707 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
11708 @end itemize
11709
11710 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
11711 and output done by the program you are debugging.
11712
11713 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
11714 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
11715 in this way.
11716
11717 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
11718 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
11719 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
11720 stop.
11721
11722 @itemize @bullet
11723 @item
11724 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
11725 @end itemize
11726
11727 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
11728 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
11729 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
11730 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
11731 and the source.
11732
11733 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
11734 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
11735
11736 @quotation
11737 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
11738 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
11739 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
11740 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
11741 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
11742 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
11743 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
11744 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
11745 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
11746 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
11747
11748 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
11749 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
11750 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
11751 @end quotation
11752
11753 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
11754 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
11755 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
11756 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
11757
11758 @example
11759 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
11760 @end example
11761
11762 @noindent
11763 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
11764 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
11765 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
11766
11767 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
11768 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
11769
11770 @table @kbd
11771 @item C-h m
11772 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
11773
11774 @item M-s
11775 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
11776 update the display window to show the current file and location.
11777
11778 @item M-n
11779 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
11780 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
11781 to show the current file and location.
11782
11783 @item M-i
11784 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
11785 display window accordingly.
11786
11787 @item M-x gdb-nexti
11788 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
11789 display window accordingly.
11790
11791 @item C-c C-f
11792 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
11793 @code{finish} command.
11794
11795 @item M-c
11796 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
11797 command.
11798
11799 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
11800
11801 @item M-u
11802 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
11803 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
11804 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
11805
11806 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
11807
11808 @item M-d
11809 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
11810 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
11811
11812 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
11813
11814 @item C-x &
11815 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
11816 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
11817 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
11818 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
11819 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
11820
11821 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
11822 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
11823 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
11824 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
11825 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
11826 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
11827 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
11828 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
11829 @end table
11830
11831 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
11832 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
11833
11834 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
11835 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
11836 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
11837 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
11838 frame.
11839
11840 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
11841 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
11842 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
11843 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
11844 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
11845 to correspond properly with the code.
11846
11847 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
11848 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
11849 @ignore
11850 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
11851 @kindex Epoch
11852 @kindex inspect
11853
11854 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
11855 called the @code{epoch}
11856 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
11857 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
11858 each value is printed in its own window.
11859 @end ignore
11860
11861 @node GDB Bugs
11862 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
11863 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
11864 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
11865
11866 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
11867
11868 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
11869 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
11870 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
11871 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
11872
11873 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
11874 information that enables us to fix the bug.
11875
11876 @menu
11877 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
11878 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
11879 @end menu
11880
11881 @node Bug Criteria
11882 @section Have you found a bug?
11883 @cindex bug criteria
11884
11885 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
11886
11887 @itemize @bullet
11888 @cindex fatal signal
11889 @cindex debugger crash
11890 @cindex crash of debugger
11891 @item
11892 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
11893 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
11894
11895 @cindex error on valid input
11896 @item
11897 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
11898 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
11899 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
11900
11901 @cindex invalid input
11902 @item
11903 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
11904 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
11905 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
11906 for traditional practice''.
11907
11908 @item
11909 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
11910 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
11911 @end itemize
11912
11913 @node Bug Reporting
11914 @section How to report bugs
11915 @cindex bug reports
11916 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
11917
11918 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
11919 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
11920 contact that organization first.
11921
11922 You can find contact information for many support companies and
11923 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
11924 distribution.
11925 @c should add a web page ref...
11926
11927 In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
11928 @value{GDBN} to this addresses:
11929
11930 @example
11931 bug-gdb@@gnu.org
11932 @end example
11933
11934 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
11935 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
11936 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
11937 @samp{bug-gdb}.
11938
11939 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
11940 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
11941 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
11942 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
11943 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
11944 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
11945 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
11946 bug reports to the mailing list.
11947
11948 As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
11949
11950 @example
11951 @sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
11952 Free Software Foundation Inc.
11953 59 Temple Place - Suite 330
11954 Boston, MA 02111-1307
11955 USA
11956 @end example
11957
11958 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
11959 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
11960 fact or leave it out, state it!
11961
11962 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
11963 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
11964 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
11965 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
11966 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
11967 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
11968 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
11969 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
11970 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
11971
11972 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
11973 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
11974 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
11975 self-contained.
11976
11977 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
11978 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
11979 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
11980 bugs properly.
11981
11982 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
11983
11984 @itemize @bullet
11985 @item
11986 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
11987 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
11988 version}.
11989
11990 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
11991 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
11992
11993 @item
11994 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
11995 version number.
11996
11997 @item
11998 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
11999 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
12000
12001 @item
12002 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12003 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12004 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12005 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12006 compilers.
12007
12008 @item
12009 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12010 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12011 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12012 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12013
12014 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12015 and then we might not encounter the bug.
12016
12017 @item
12018 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12019 reproduce the bug.
12020
12021 @item
12022 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12023 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12024
12025 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12026 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12027 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12028 a chance to make a mistake.
12029
12030 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12031 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12032 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12033 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12034 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12035 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12036 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12037 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12038
12039 @item
12040 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12041 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12042 it by context, not by line number.
12043
12044 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12045 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
12046
12047 @end itemize
12048
12049 Here are some things that are not necessary:
12050
12051 @itemize @bullet
12052 @item
12053 A description of the envelope of the bug.
12054
12055 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12056 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12057 changes will not affect it.
12058
12059 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12060 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12061 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12062 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12063
12064 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12065 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12066 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12067 less time, and so on.
12068
12069 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12070 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12071
12072 @item
12073 A patch for the bug.
12074
12075 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12076 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12077 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12078 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12079
12080 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12081 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12082 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12083 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12084
12085 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12086 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12087 help us to understand.
12088
12089 @item
12090 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12091
12092 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12093 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12094 @end itemize
12095
12096 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12097 @c and consists of the two following files:
12098 @c rluser.texinfo
12099 @c inc-hist.texinfo
12100 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12101 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12102 @include rluser.texinfo
12103 @include inc-hist.texinfo
12104
12105
12106 @node Formatting Documentation
12107 @appendix Formatting Documentation
12108
12109 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12110 @cindex reference card
12111 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12112 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12113 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12114 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12115 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12116 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12117
12118 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12119 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12120
12121 @example
12122 make refcard.dvi
12123 @end example
12124
12125 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12126 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12127 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12128 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12129 your @sc{dvi} output program.
12130
12131 @cindex documentation
12132
12133 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12134 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12135 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12136 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12137 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12138 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12139
12140 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12141 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12142 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12143 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12144 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12145 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12146 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12147 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12148
12149 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12150 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12151 @code{makeinfo}.
12152
12153 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12154 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12155 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12156
12157 @example
12158 cd gdb
12159 make gdb.info
12160 @end example
12161
12162 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12163 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12164 Texinfo definitions file.
12165
12166 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12167 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12168 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12169 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12170 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12171 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12172 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12173
12174 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12175 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12176 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12177 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12178 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12179 directory.
12180
12181 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12182 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12183 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12184 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12185
12186 @example
12187 make gdb.dvi
12188 @end example
12189
12190 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
12191
12192 @node Installing GDB
12193 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12194 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12195 @cindex installation
12196
12197 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12198 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12199 build the @code{gdb} program.
12200 @iftex
12201 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12202 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12203 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12204 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12205 @end iftex
12206
12207 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12208 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12209 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12210
12211 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12212 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12213
12214 @table @code
12215 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12216 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12217
12218 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12219 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12220
12221 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12222 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12223
12224 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12225 @sc{gnu} include files
12226
12227 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12228 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12229
12230 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12231 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12232
12233 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12234 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12235
12236 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12237 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12238
12239 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12240 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12241 @end table
12242
12243 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12244 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12245 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12246
12247 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12248 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12249 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12250 argument.
12251
12252 For example:
12253
12254 @example
12255 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12256 ./configure @var{host}
12257 make
12258 @end example
12259
12260 @noindent
12261 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12262 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12263 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12264 correct value by examining your system.)
12265
12266 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12267 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12268 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12269 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12270
12271 @need 750
12272 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12273 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12274 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12275
12276 @example
12277 sh configure @var{host}
12278 @end example
12279
12280 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12281 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12282 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12283 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12284 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12285
12286 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12287 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12288 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12289
12290 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12291 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12292
12293 @example
12294 @group
12295 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12296 ../configure @var{host}
12297 @end group
12298 @end example
12299
12300 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12301 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12302 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12303 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12304 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12305
12306 @menu
12307 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12308 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12309 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12310 @end menu
12311
12312 @node Separate Objdir
12313 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12314
12315 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12316 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12317 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12318 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12319 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12320 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12321 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12322 program specified there.
12323
12324 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12325 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12326 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12327 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12328 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12329 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12330
12331 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12332 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12333
12334 @example
12335 @group
12336 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12337 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12338 cd ../gdb-sun4
12339 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12340 make
12341 @end group
12342 @end example
12343
12344 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12345 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12346 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12347 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12348 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12349 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12350
12351 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12352 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12353 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12354 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12355 You specify a cross-debugging target by
12356 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12357
12358 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12359 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12360 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12361
12362 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12363 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12364 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12365 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12366 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12367
12368 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12369 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12370 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12371 with each other.
12372
12373 @node Config Names
12374 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12375
12376 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12377 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12378 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12379 of information in the following pattern:
12380
12381 @example
12382 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12383 @end example
12384
12385 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12386 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12387 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12388
12389 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12390 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12391 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12392 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12393 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12394 abbreviations---for example:
12395
12396 @smallexample
12397 % sh config.sub i386-linux
12398 i386-pc-linux-gnu
12399 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
12400 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12401 % sh config.sub hp9k700
12402 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12403 % sh config.sub sun4
12404 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12405 % sh config.sub sun3
12406 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12407 % sh config.sub i986v
12408 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12409 @end smallexample
12410
12411 @noindent
12412 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12413 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12414
12415 @node Configure Options
12416 @section @code{configure} options
12417
12418 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12419 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12420 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12421 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12422
12423 @example
12424 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12425 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12426 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12427 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12428 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12429 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12430 @var{host}
12431 @end example
12432
12433 @noindent
12434 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12435 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12436 @samp{--}.
12437
12438 @table @code
12439 @item --help
12440 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12441
12442 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
12443 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12444 @file{@var{dir}}.
12445
12446 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12447 Configure the source to install programs under directory
12448 @file{@var{dir}}.
12449
12450 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12451 @need 2000
12452 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12453 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12454 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12455 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12456 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12457 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12458 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12459 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12460 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12461 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12462 @var{dirname}.
12463
12464 @item --norecursion
12465 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12466 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12467
12468 @item --target=@var{target}
12469 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12470 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12471 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12472
12473 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12474
12475 @item @var{host} @dots{}
12476 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12477
12478 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12479 @end table
12480
12481 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12482 needed for special purposes only.
12483
12484 @node Index
12485 @unnumbered Index
12486
12487 @printindex cp
12488
12489 @tex
12490 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12491 % meantime:
12492 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12493 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12494 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12495 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12496 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12497 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12498 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12499 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12500 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12501 \page\colophon
12502 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12503 @end tex
12504
12505 @contents
12506 @bye